Catalog IC 10 English 2011

Transcription

Catalog IC 10 English 2011
© Siemens AG 2010
Commanding and Signaling
Devices
10/2
10/4
10/7
10/9
10/11
10/13
10/17
10/18
10/20
10/25
10/31
10/34
10/42
10/44
10/48
10/53
10/63
10/67
10/68
10/69
10/70
10/71
10/73
10/78
10/79
10/81
10/83
10/86
10/87
10/89
10/90
10/91
10/93
10/95
Introduction
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator
Lights, 16 mm
General data
Complete units
Actuators and indicators
Contact blocks and lampholders
Accessories and Spare Parts
Insert labels and insert caps
Name plates
Mounting parts and components
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator
Lights, 22 mm
General data
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic,
Round, 22 mm
Complete units
Coordinate switches, complete
Actuators and indicators
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic,
Square, 26 mm × 26 mm
Complete units
Actuators and indicators
Actuators and Indicators, Metal,
Round, 22 mm
Complete units
Actuators and indicators
Components for Actuators and Indicators
Contact blocks and lampholders
AS-Interface F adapters for
EMERGENCY-STOP devices
Special locks
Inscriptions
Laser inscriptions
Inscriptions by laser printer
Insert labels
Name plates
Accessories and Spare Parts
Buttons and lenses
Lamps, acoustic signal transformers
and keys
Protective covers
Miscellaneous accessories
Enclosures
General data
Enclosures with standard fittings
Empty enclosures
Customer-specific enclosures
Contact blocks and lampholders
Inscription labels for enclosures
Accessories for enclosures
Enclosures for AS-Interface
General data
AS-Interface enclosures with standard
fittings
10/98 Components for AS-Interface
enclosures
IK PI1) Enclosures and Front Panel Modules
for AS-Interface
10/96
10/97
10/99
3SB3 Two-Hand Operation Consoles
Plastic and metal enclosures
3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches
10/100 3SE7 metal enclosures
10/104 3SF2 cable-operated switches for
AS-Interface
3SE2, 3SE3 Foot Switches
10/105 Plastic and metal enclosures
8WD4 Signaling Columns
10/107 General data
10/110 8WD42 signaling columns,
50 mm diameter
10/112 8WD44 signaling columns,
70 mm diameter
8WD5 Integrated Signal Lamps
10/115 8WD53 integrated signal lamps,
70 mm diameter
More technical information
can be found at
www.siemens.com/industrialcontrols/support
under Product List:
- Technical specifications
under Entry List:
- Updates
- Downloads
- FAQ
- Manuals
- Characteristics
- Certificates
and at
www.siemens.com/industrialcontrols/configurators
- Configurators
1)
See Catalog IK PI.
Siemens
Siemens
IC 10
IC· 10
2011
· 2011
10
Price Groups
PG 101, 102, 121
10
© Siemens AG 2010
Commanding and Signaling Devices
Introduction
■ Overview
3SB2
3SB30, 3SB32
3SB31, 3SB33
3SB35, 3SB36
16 mm
Plastic, round
22 mm
Plastic, round
26 mm × 26 mm
Plastic, square
22 mm
Metal, round
✓1)
✓1)
--✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
--✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
----
✓
✓
✓
----
----
✓
--
✓
✓
✓
--
✓
--
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
---
✓ (with solder connections)
✓
✓
✓ (with solder connections)
✓
✓
✓ (with solder connections)
✓
✓
✓
--✓
--
-✓
✓
✓
✓
-✓
✓
✓
✓
-✓
✓
✓
✓
Pushbuttons and indicator lights
Designs
Nominal diameter
Version
Actuators
Pushbuttons and switches
Illuminated pushbuttons and switches
Mushroom pushbuttons
Push-pull buttons
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons
Selector switches
Key-operated switches
Special actuators
Coordinate switches
Twin pushbuttons
Potentiometer drives
Indicators
Indicator lights
Acoustic signaling devices
Contact blocks
Single-pole
Two-pole
10
Lampholders
Wedge bases
BA 9s bases
With integrated LED
Connections
Plug-in connection
Screw terminals
Spring-type terminals
Solder pins
AS-Interface
AS-Interface solutions
✓ Standard
Commanding and signaling devices of the SIRIUS 3SB3 series
can be connected to the AS-Interface communication system
quickly and easily with the help of various solutions.
-- Not available
❏ Optional
1)
Only pushbuttons, no pushbutton switches.
For AS-Interface solutions, see catalog IK PI
"Industrial Communication for Automation & Drives".
AS-Interface front panel modules
AS-Interface EMERGENCY-STOP according to ISO 13850
The front panel module has one 4I/4O slave for connection of
four 3SB3 commanding or signaling devices (see Catalog IK PI).
Using a special F adapter, EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850 (former EN 418) can be directly connected
through the standard AS-Interface with safety-oriented communication (see page 10/68).
AS-Interface enclosures
Enclosures with standard fittings are listed in this catalog. For
customized enclosures, use the 3SB configurator to select the
elements for equipping (see page 10/96).
10/2
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
Note:
For safety characteristics see "Appendix"
--> "Standards and approvals" --> "Overview"
© Siemens AG 2010
Commanding and Signaling Devices
Introduction
3SB38
3SB38 6
3SE7, 3SF2
3SE29
Enclosures
Two-hand operation
consoles
Cable-operated
switches
Foot switches
✓
✓
✓
✓
-✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
❏
✓
✓
---✓
✓
-----
✓
✓
--
❏
❏
--
--✓
----
✓
✓
❏
❏
✓
--
---
✓
----
✓
✓
---
-✓
-✓
-✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
-❏
✓
✓
❏
-❏
❏
✓
--❏
✓
✓
-✓
❏
--
8WD42, 8WD44
8WD53
Signaling columns
Integrated signal lamps
✓
--
✓
--
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
---
Enclosures
Plastic
Metal
Actuators
Pushbuttons and switches
Illuminated pushbuttons and switches
Mushroom pushbuttons
Push-pull buttons
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons
Selector switches
Key-operated switches
Bowden wires
Indicators
Indicator lights
Acoustic signaling devices
Contact blocks
Single-pole
Two-pole
Three-pole
Four-pole
Screw terminals
Spring-type terminals
Molded cables
Plug-in connection
AS-Interface
10
Connections
Enclosures
Plastic
Metal
Lighting
Incandescent lamps
LEDs
Flashlights
Connections
Screw terminals
Spring-type terminals
AS-Interface
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/3
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
General data
For PCB mounting
■ Overview
The 3SB2 pushbuttons and indicator lights are provided for front
plate mounting and rear connection with flat connectors. For use
on printed circuit boards, contact blocks and lampholders with
solder pins are also available.
For use on printed circuit boards, special contact blocks and
lampholders for soldering into the printed circuit board are available. For this purpose, the contact blocks and lampholders are
fitted with 0.8 mm × 0.8 mm solder pins of length 3.5 mm.
F
Standards
IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1,
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1,
IEC 60947-5-5, EN 60947-5-5 for EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbuttons.
C
D
E
B
Version with flat connector
A
G
G
D
C1
G
NSD0_00010b
F1
Actuator
Front panel
Spacer
Holder
Lampholder/
actuator
F PCB
A
B
C
D
E
A1
F2
E
D
C1
A2
Connection methods
B1
E
D
NSD0_00001b
10
A3
Flat connectors
Solder pin connections
C2
B2
F2
The terminals are indicated in the corresponding
tables by the symbols shown on orange
backgrounds.
■ Application
A1 Button, flat
A2 Illuminated button, flat
A3 Screw lens for indicator light
B1 Insert label, for labeling
B2 Insert cap, for labeling
C1
C2
D
E
Collar with extruded front ring
Collar for indicator light
Frame for rectangular design
Wedge base lamp, W2 x 4.6d
F1 Holders
F2 Lampholder with holder
G Contact block for snapping onto the holder
and/or onto the lampholder(1NO or 1NC)
10/4
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
The devices are climate-proof and suitable for marine
applications.
Safety EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons according to
ISO 13850
For controls according to IEC 60204-1 or EN 60204-1
(VDE 0113 Part 1), the mushroom pushbuttons of the 3SB2
series are suitable for use as safety EMERGENCY-STOP
pushbuttons.
Safety circuits
IEC 60947-5-1 and EN 60947-5-1 require positive opening, i.e.
for the purposes of personal safety, the assured opening of NC
contacts is expressly stipulated for the electrical equipment of
machines in all safety circuits and marked according to
IEC 60947-5-1 with the symbol
.
Category 4 according to EN 954-1 can be attained with the
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons if the corresponding failsafe evaluation units are selected and correctly installed,
e.g. the 3TK28 safety relays or matching units from the ASIsafe,
SIMATIC or SINUMERIK product ranges.
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
General data
■ Technical specifications
Type
3SB2
Contact blocks and lampholders
Standards
Rated insulation voltage Ui
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1
IEC 60947-5-5, EN 60947-5-5
V
250
Conventional thermal current Ith
A
10
• Alternating current AC-12
- At Ue = 24 ... 230 V
A
10
• Alternating current AC-15
- At Ue = 24 ... 230 V
A
4
• Direct current DC-12
- At Ue = 24 V
- At Ue = 60 V
- At Ue = 110 V
- At Ue = 230 V
A
A
A
A
6
5
2.5
1
• Direct current DC-13
- At Ue = 24 V
- At Ue = 60 V
- At Ue = 110 V
- At Ue = 230 V
A
A
A
A
3
1.5
0.7
0.3
Rated operational current Ie at rated operational voltage Ue
Contact stability
• Test voltage/test current
Lamps
• Bases
• Rated voltage
• Rated power, max.
5 V / 1 mA
V
W
Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d
6, 12, 24, 30, 48, 60
1
Short-circuit protection weld-free acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
• DIAZED fuse links, utilization category gG
• Miniature circuit breaker with C characteristic acc. to IEC 60898
10 A TDz, 16 A Dz
10 A
Electrical endurance
• For utilization category AC-15 with 3RT10 15 to 3RT10 26 contactors
10 × 106 operating cycles
Mechanical endurance
10 × 106 operating cycles
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529
• Connection of contact blocks and lampholders behind the front panel
• Contact chambers of the contact blocks behind the front panel
IP00
IP40
Finger-safe acc. to EN 61140 and BGV A3
With voltages > 50 V AC or 120 V DC, insulation sleeves must be
fitted to the unassigned tab connections.
V
V
250 AC
60; 1 W
Uninterrupted current
A
5
Switching capacity
10
Data according to UL and CSA
Rated voltage
• Contact blocks
• Indicator light (lamp with wedge base W2 × 4.6 d)
B 300, R 300
Actuators and indicators
Mechanical endurance
• Pushbuttons
• Actuators, rotary or latching
• Illuminated pushbuttons
10 × 106 operating cycles
3 × 105 operating cycles
3 × 106 operating cycles
Climatic withstand capability
Climate-proof; suitable for marine applications
Ambient temperature
• During operation, non-illuminated devices and complete with LED
• During operation, devices with incandescent lamp
• During storage, transport
°C
°C
°C
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529
• Actuators and indicators
• Actuators and indicators with protective cap
IP65
IP67
Protective measures
• For mounting in metal front plates and enclosures
The actuators and lens assemblies must not be included in the
protective measures.
The protective measure "Total insulation" is retained.
• For fitting into enclosures with total insulation
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
• Shock amplitude
• Shock duration
• Shock form
–25 ... +70
–25 ... +60
–40 ... +80
ms
≤ 50 g
11
Half-sine
For further technical information, see page 10/1.
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/5
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
General data
Configuration
For PCB mounting
Design
The command point comprises the actuator – e.g. 3SB2 pushbutton, illuminated pushbutton or indicator light –, which is
mounted in the front plate, and a contact block and a lampholder
which are soldered to the PCB. For this purpose, the contact
blocks and lampholders are fitted with 0.8 mm × 0.8 mm solder
pins of length 3.5 mm.
Mounting and fixing:
Mounting dimensions according to EN 50007
(not applicable to EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons)
+0,2
Mounting dimensions according to EN 50007.
The actuators are mounted in the same way as 3SB2 front plate
mounting devices.
The contact blocks and lampholders are plugged into the
printed circuit board by means of their solder pins and can be
flow-soldered. After soldering, the devices must be flush with the
board and perpendicular to it. The printed circuit board must be
supported on spacing bolts so that it cannot sag or bend more
than 0.1 mm.
1...6
1,5...2,5
44-0,2
20,2
a
Minimum clearance
a
b
Round version
19
19
Square version
without inscription label
21
21
Round and square version
with inscription label
21
32
For 2 selector switches with 3 switch positions,
latching, side by side
21
21
Length a of spacing bolts:
a = 44-0.2 minus front plate thickness.
When using name plates, the
length a is reduced by 0.8 mm.
NSD0_00011a
19
Illuminated pushbutton with solder pin connection
To avoid bending the PCB when the pushbuttons are operated,
sufficient spacing bolts must be provided as shown in the table
below:
PCB thickness
Max. distance between
spacing bolts
1.5 mm
80 mm
2.5 mm
150 mm
One or two contact blocks can be mounted on the holder. They
are inserted into the holder with slide slots and held down with
two snap brackets.
These details are based on epoxy resin glass fiber mat.
When using EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons Always 50 mm
7,6
50
Solder pin spacing
19
Pushbutton (flat) with holder and contact block
If a command point is fitted with an indicator light or illuminated
pushbutton, a lamp socket with lampholder must be used instead of a holder. It is suitable for incandescent lamps or LEDs
with bases of type W2 × 4.6d.
10/6
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
NO, NC
La
NO, NC
NSD0_00012a
Solder terminal Ø1.3+0,1
12,7 Ø4,2
10,16
8
Ø19
1...6
For mounting, the actuator or the lens assembly is inserted from
the front into the hole in the front plate. Four small nubs ensure a
secure fitting in the hole. The holder is plugged on from the side
and snaps automatically into place. The module is fixed to the
holder with 2 screws so that it is immune to vibrations.
NSD0_00140a
10
a
NSD0_00002a
b
16,2
Mounting and fixing:
a
Two design versions can be mounted:
• Round design: The 3SB2 pushbuttons and indicator lights are
assembled with the modules – actuator, holder, contact block
and lampholder. Depending on the specific application, various versions can be assembled. Complete units are offered
for the most commonly used applications.
• Square design: With square, black frames the round units can
be given a square look. The frames are inserted underneath
the round actuators. Further mounting is the same as for the
round version.
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Complete units
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Contact
blocks
Color of
handle
DT Flat connectors
Order No.
Illuminated pushbutton
with raised button
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Pushbuttons
with flat button
1 NO
1 NC
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
Black
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear1)
}
B
}
B
}
B
}
B
3SB2202-0AB01
3SB2203-0AB01
3SB2203-0AC01
3SB2202-0AD01
3SB2202-0AE01
3SB2202-0AF01
3SB2202-0AG01
3SB2202-0AH01
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with flat button
Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d2)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
Red
Yellow1)
Green
Blue
Clear1)
}
B
}
B
}
3SB2207-0AC01
3SB2206-0AD01
3SB2206-0AE01
3SB2206-0AF01
3SB2206-0AH01
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with flat button
Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d
with incandescent lamp 24 V
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
Red
Yellow1)
Green
Blue
Clear1)
}
B
}
B
}
3SB2227-0AC01
3SB2226-0AD01
3SB2226-0AE01
3SB2226-0AF01
3SB2226-0AH01
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with raised button
1 NO
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
Black
Red
Yellow
Blue
Clear1)
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2202-0LB01
3SB2203-0LC01
3SB2202-0LD01
3SB2202-0LF01
3SB2202-0LH01
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with raised button
Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d2)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
Red
Yellow1)
Green
Blue
Clear1)
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2207-0LC01
3SB2206-0LD01
3SB2206-0LE01
3SB2206-0LF01
3SB2206-0LH01
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with raised button
Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d
with incandescent lamp 24 V
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
Red
Yellow1)
Green
Blue
Clear1)
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2227-0LC01
3SB2226-0LD01
3SB2226-0LE01
3SB2226-0LF01
3SB2226-0LH01
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Red
}
3SB2203-1AC01
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
1 NC
pushbuttons
3)
acc. to ISO 13850, latching
Latches automatically when pressed;
unlatches by turning the mushroom head
anticlockwise,
with yellow name plate,
with inscription "NOT-HALT"
4)
10
Pushbutton
with flat button
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
1)
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
2)
For wedge base lamps, see Accessories.
3)
The mushroom pushbutton cannot be combined with 3SB29 02-0AB name
plate or 3SB29 02-0AA single frame.
4)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/7
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Complete units
Version
Contact
blocks
Color of
handle
DT Flat connectors
Order No.
Selector switch
PG
Price
per PU
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB2202-2AB01
3SB2202-2AC01
3SB2202-2AE01
3SB2202-2AG01
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Selector switches,
3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 × 62° operating angle,
latching
1 NO, 1 NO
1 NO, 1 NO
1 NO, 1 NO
1 NO, 1 NO
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB2210-2DB01
3SB2210-2DC01
3SB2210-2DE01
3SB2210-2DG01
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Selector switches,
3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 × 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
1 NO, 1 NO
1 NO, 1 NO
1 NO, 1 NO
1 NO, 1 NO
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB2210-2EB01
3SB2210-2EC01
3SB2210-2EE01
3SB2210-2EG01
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Key
removal
position
DT Flat connectors
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
PS*
PG
Contact
blocks
Lock No.
Order No.
CES key-operated switches, 1 NO
2 switch positions
1 NO
Switching sequence O-I,
62° operating angle,
latching
10
PS*
Selector switches,
2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I,
62° operating angle,
latching
Version
SB2
SB2
CES key-operated switches, 1 NO, 1 NO SB2
3 switch positions
1 NO, 1 NO SB2
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 × 62° operating angle,
CES key-operated switch latching
CES key-operated switches, 1 NO, 1 NO SB2
3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 × 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
Version
Color of
screw lens
Price
per PU
O
O+I
}
B
3SB2202-4LA01
3SB2202-4LB01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
O
I + O + II
B
B
3SB2210-4PA01
3SB2210-4PB01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
O
B
3SB2210-4QA01
1
1 unit
102
DT Flat connectors
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
PS*
PG
Order No.
Price
per PU
Indicator lights
Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d
without lamp1)
Red
Yellow
Green
White
Clear
}
B
}
}
B
3SB2204-6BC06
3SB2204-6BD06
3SB2204-6BE06
3SB2204-6BG06
3SB2204-6BH06
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Indicator lights
Lampholder W2 x 4.6 d
with incandescent lamp 24 V
Red
Yellow
Green
White
Clear
}
B
}
}
B
3SB2224-6BC06
3SB2224-6BD06
3SB2224-6BE06
3SB2224-6BG06
3SB2224-6BH06
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Indicator light
1)
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
For wedge base lamps, see Accessories.
10/8
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Actuators and indicators
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Pushbuttons
with flat button
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear1)
}
}
B
}
A
}
B
Illuminated pushbuttons
with flat button
Red
Yellow1)
Green
Blue
White
Clear1)
Pushbuttons
with raised button
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
PS*
PG
3SB2000-0AB01
3SB2000-0AC01
3SB2000-0AD01
3SB2000-0AE01
3SB2000-0AF01
3SB2000-0AG01
3SB2000-0AH01
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
}
B
}
B
}
B
3SB2001-0AC01
3SB2001-0AD01
3SB2001-0AE01
3SB2001-0AF01
3SB2000-0AG01
3SB2000-0AH01
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Yellow
Blue
White
Clear1)
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2000-0LB01
3SB2000-0LC01
3SB2000-0LD01
3SB2000-0LF01
3SB2000-0LG01
3SB2000-0LH01
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with raised button
Red
Yellow1)
Green
Blue
Clear1)
B
B
A
B
B
3SB2001-0LC01
3SB2001-0LD01
3SB2001-0LE01
3SB2001-0LF01
3SB2000-0LH01
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons
acc. to ISO 13850, latching2)
Latches automatically when pressed; unlatches
by turning the mushroom head anticlockwise
Red
}
3SB2000-1AC01
1
1 unit
102
Pushbuttons
Pushbutton and
illuminated pushbutton
with flat button
Pushbutton and
illuminated pushbutton
with raised button
1)
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
2)
The mushroom pushbutton cannot be combined with 3SB29 02-0AB name
plate or 3SB29 02-0AA single frame.
Version
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Selector switches with 2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I,
62° operating angle,
latching
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
Selector switches with 2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I,
50° operating angle,
momentary contact type (reset from the right)
Black
Red
Green
Selector switches with 2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I,
90° operating angle,
latching
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
PS*
PG
3SB2000-2AB01
3SB2000-2AC01
3SB2000-2AE01
3SB2000-2AG01
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
C
B
B
3SB2000-2BB01
3SB2000-2BC01
3SB2000-2BE01
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Black
Red
Green
White
B
B
B
B
3SB2000-2HB01
3SB2000-2HC01
3SB2000-2HE01
3SB2000-2HG01
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Selector switches with 3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 x 62° operating angle,
latching
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB2000-2DB01
3SB2000-2DC01
3SB2000-2DE01
3SB2000-2DG01
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Selector switches with 3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB2000-2EB01
3SB2000-2EC01
3SB2000-2EE01
3SB2000-2EG01
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Selector switches with 3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 x 90° operating angle,
latching
Black
B
3SB2000-2JB01
1
1 unit
102
Selector switches
Selector switch
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/9
10
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Lock No. Key
removal
position
DT Order No.
CES key-operated switches
with 2 keys,
2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I,
62° operating angle,
latching
SB2
O+I
O
B
}
CES key-operated switches
with 2 keys,
2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I,
50° operating angle,
CES key-operated switch momentary contact
CES key-operated switches
with 2 keys,
3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 x 62° operating angle,
latching
SB2
O
SB2
CES key-operated switches
with 2 keys,
3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact
SB2
Version
Color of
screw lens
DT Order No.
Indicator lights
with concentric rings
(inscription by inserting a cap is not
possible)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
}
B
}
B
}
B
Indicator lights, smooth
for inscription by inserting a cap1)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
PS*
PG
3SB2000-4LB01
3SB2000-4LA01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
}
3SB2000-4MA01
1
1 unit
102
I+O+II
O
B
B
3SB2000-4PB01
3SB2000-4PA01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
O
B
3SB2000-4QA01
1
1 unit
102
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
PS*
PG
3SB2001-6BC06
3SB2001-6BD06
3SB2001-6BE06
3SB2001-6BF06
3SB2001-6BG06
3SB2001-6BH06
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
3SB2001-6CC06
3SB2001-6CD06
3SB2001-6CE06
3SB2001-6CF06
3SB2001-6CH06
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Key-operated switches
Price
per PU
Indicator lights
10
Indicator light
1)
For insert caps, see Accessories.
10/10
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Contact blocks and lampholders
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Diagram
DT Flat connectors
Operating travel
Contact closed
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
PS*
PG
1
5 units
102
Contact open
Order No.
Price
per PU
Contact blocks and lampholders with
flat connectors 2 × 2.8 – 0.8 mm according to IEC 60760
Holders for fixing the actuator and the contact blocks
}
Holders for 2 contact blocks
Inscription with identification
number 1-2
3SB2908-0AA
Holder
Lampholders with holder for fixing the actuator and the contact blocks
Lampholders
W2 x 4.6 d
without lamp
X1
(L+)
Lampholders
W2 x 4.6 d
X1
(L+)
X2
(L-)
}
3SB2304-2A
1
1 unit
102
NSD00003
X2
(L-)
NSD00003
• With 6 V incandescent lamp
• With 24 V incandescent lamp
B
3SB2304-2F
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2304-2H
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2404-3D
1
1 unit
102
}
3SB2404-0B
1
1 unit
102
}
3SB2404-0C
1
1 unit
102
Lampholder
Voltage reducers1)
For connecting the
3SB29 08-1AE lamp (48 V) to
230 V AC
X 1
X 2
N S D 0 _ 0 0 0 5 a
Voltage reducer
10
Contact blocks for fixing in the holder or lampholder
1 NO
3
NSD00006
Contact blocks
with one contact2)
NSD00008
3-4
0 1
mm
4
3)
1
2
1)
Use fixpoint terminal according to IEC 60439-1.
2)
For plug-in and insulation sleeves, see Accessories.
3)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
3
4
NSD00009
NSD00007
1 NC
Contact block
2
1-2
0 1
mm
2
3
4
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/11
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Contact blocks and lampholders
Version
Diagram
DT Solder pin
connections
Operating travel
Contact closed
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
PS*
PG
Contact open
NSD0_00015
3-4
0 1
mm
Contact blocks and lampholders with solder pins
Lampholders
Wedge base W2 x 4.6 d1)
(L+) X1
3
Order No.
4
2,3
NSD00013
Holders for contact block with
solder pins
For fixing the actuators in the
front panel
2
Price
per PU
C
3SB2908-0AB
1
5 units
102
B
3SB2455-2A
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-0B
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-0C
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-0J
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-0E
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-0F
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-1B
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-1C
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-1J
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-1E
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB2455-1F
1
1 unit
102
(L-) X2
Holder
Contact blocks
3
NSD0_00015
NSD00006
1 NO
3-4
0 1
mm
4
1
2
Contact block
with solder pins
1 NO + 1 NC
2)
3
4
2,3
NSD0_00017
1-2
0 1
mm
13 21
2
3
4
1,6
NSD00019
NSD00018
2)
NSD00007
1 NC
2
21-22
13-14
0 1
mm
14 22
2
3
4
13 23
NSD00020
1,6
1 NO + 1 NO
NSD00021
13-14
23-24
0 1
mm
14 24
2
3
4
2,3
2)
11 21
NSD00023
NSD00022
1 NC + 1 NC
21-22
11-12
0 1
mm
10
12 22
2
3
4
1,6
1 NO
13 X1
NSD00024
Contact blocks and lampholders, wedge base W2 x 4.6 d1)
NSD01082
13-14
0
1
mm
1 NC
Contact block and
lampholder
with solder pins
2)
21 X1
22 X2
NSD00025
14 X2
2
3
4
2,3
NSD01083
21-22
0
1
mm
2
3
4
1,6
1 NO + 1 NC
2)
13 21 X1
NSD00019
21-22
13-14
0 1
mm
14 22 X2
2
3
4
1,6
1 NO + 1 NO
13 23 X1
NSD00021
13-14
23-24
0 1
mm
14 24 X2
2
3
4
2,3
1 NC + 1 NC
2)
NSD00023
11 21 X1
21-22
11-12
12 22 X2
0 1
mm
2
3
4
1,6
1)
The lamp is not included in the scope of supply.
2)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
10/12
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Insert labels and insert caps
■ Overview
Clear pushbuttons, illuminated pushbuttons and indicator lights
can be fitted with insert labels and caps for identification
purposes.
The insert labels and insert caps are made of a milkytransparent plastic with black lettering; they can be fitted in any
90° angle.
Inscriptions
The inscriptions have upper case initial letters. Graphic symbols,
including those not listed in the catalog, are according to
ISO 7000 or IEC 60417.
For customized inscriptions, see "Options".
■ Selection and ordering data
Inscription/Symbol
Symbol No.
DT Insert labels
For pushbuttons and
illuminated pushbuttons, flat
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
For self-inscription
Blank
B
3SB2901-4AA
100 10 units
102
Ein
Aus
Auf
Ab
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-4AB
3SB2901-4AC
3SB2901-4AD
3SB2901-4AE
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
Vor
Zurück
Rechts
Links
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-4AF
3SB2901-4AG
3SB2901-4AH
3SB2901-4AJ
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
Halt
Zu
Langsam
Störung
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-4AK
3SB2901-4AL
3SB2901-4AN
3SB2901-4AQ
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
On
Start
Stop
Reset
Test
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-4EB
3SB2901-4EK
3SB2901-4EL
3SB2901-4EM
3SB2901-4EN
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
0
1
2
3
4
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-4RA
3SB2901-4RB
3SB2901-4RC
3SB2901-4RD
3SB2901-4RE
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
5
6
7
8
9
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-4RF
3SB2901-4RG
3SB2901-4RH
3SB2901-4RJ
3SB2901-4RK
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
Graphic ON/OFF symbols
O (Off)
5008 IEC
B
3SB2901-4MB
100 10 units
102
I (On)
5007 IEC
B
3SB2901-4MC
100 10 units
102
II (On)
--
B
3SB2901-4MD
100 10 units
102
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/13
10
With inscription
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Insert labels and insert caps
Inscription/Symbol
Symbol No.
DT Insert labels
For pushbuttons and
illuminated pushbuttons, flat
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Graphic equipment symbols
Electric motor
0011 ISO
B
3SB2901-4PA
100 10 units
102
Horn
5014 IEC
B
3SB2901-4PB
100 10 units
102
Pump
0134 ISO
B
3SB2901-4PD
100 10 units
102
Coolant pump
0355 ISO
B
3SB2901-4PE
100 10 units
102
Motion in direction of arrow
5022 IEC
B
3SB2901-4NA
100 10 units
102
Motion in direction of arrow
--
B
3SB2901-4NB
100 10 units
102
Clockwise rotation
0004 ISO
B
3SB2901-4NC
100 10 units
102
Anticlockwise rotation
--
B
3SB2901-4ND
100 10 units
102
Fast motion
0266 ISO
B
3SB2901-4NE
100 10 units
102
Increase (plus)
5005 IEC
B
3SB2901-4NG
100 10 units
102
Decrease (minus)
5006 IEC
B
3SB2901-4MC
100 10 units
102
Clamp
--
B
3SB2901-4QB
100 10 units
102
Release
--
B
3SB2901-4QC
100 10 units
102
Brake off
0021 ISO
B
3SB2901-4QE
100 10 units
102
Lock
0022 ISO
B
3SB2901-4QF
100 10 units
102
Unlock
0023 ISO
B
3SB2901-4QG
100 10 units
102
On/Off, momentary contact
5011 IEC
B
3SB2901-4QJ
100 10 units
102
Manual operation
0096 ISO
B
3SB2901-4QK
100 10 units
102
Automatic sequence
0017 ISO
B
3SB2901-4QL
100 10 units
102
Graphic motion symbols
10
Graphic control symbols
Customized inscriptions
Any inscription
3SB2901-4AZ
1 line of text with up to 6 characters of 3 mm in height.
Please add the appropriate order code to the Order No. and specify
the line of text required.
C
K0Y
1
1 unit
102
B
K1Y or K2Y
1
1 unit
102
B
K5Y
1
1 unit
102
Other graphic symbols
B
3SB2901-4AZ
1
1 unit
102
1
1 unit
102
Please add the order code "K3Y" to the Order No. and specify the
serial number and the applied standard (ISO 7000 or IEC 60417).
Any inscription or symbol
Please add the order code "K9Y" to the Order No. and specify the
inscription or the symbol required.
10/14
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
K3Y
B
3SB2901-4AZ
K9Y
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Insert labels and insert caps
Inscription/Symbol
Symbol No.
DT Insert caps
For pushbuttons and
illuminated pushbuttons,
raised
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
For self-inscription
Blank
B
3SB2901-5AA
100 10 units
102
Aus
Auf
Zu
B
B
B
3SB2901-5AC
3SB2901-5AD
3SB2901-5AL
100 10 units
100 10 units
100 10 units
102
102
102
0
1
2
3
4
C
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-5RA
3SB2901-5RB
3SB2901-5RC
3SB2901-5RD
3SB2901-5RE
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
5
6
7
8
9
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-5RF
3SB2901-5RG
3SB2901-5RH
3SB2901-5RJ
3SB2901-5RK
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
With inscription
Graphic ON/OFF symbols
O (Off)
5008 IEC
B
3SB2901-5MB
100 10 units
102
I (On)
5007 IEC
B
3SB2901-5MC
100 10 units
102
Motion in direction of arrow
5022 IEC
B
3SB2901-5NA
100 10 units
102
Motion in direction of arrow
--
B
3SB2901-5NB
100 10 units
102
Increase (plus)
5005 IEC
B
3SB2901-5NG
100 10 units
102
Decrease (minus)
5006 IEC
B
3SB2901-5MC
100 10 units
102
Clamp
--
B
3SB2901-5QB
100 10 units
102
Release
--
B
3SB2901-5QC
100 10 units
102
Graphic motion symbols
10
Graphic control symbols
Customized inscriptions
Any inscription
3SB2901-5AZ
1 line of text with up to 6 characters of 3 mm in height.
Please add the appropriate order code to the Order No. and specify
the line of text required.
C
K0Y
1
1 unit
102
B
K1Y or K2Y
1
1 unit
102
B
K5Y
1
1 unit
102
Other graphic symbols
B
3SB2901-5AZ
1
1 unit
102
1
1 unit
102
Please add the order code "K3Y" to the Order No. and specify the
serial number and the applied standard (ISO 7000 or IEC 60417).
Any inscription or symbol
Please add the order code "K9Y" to the Order No. and specify the
inscription or the symbol required.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
K3Y
B
3SB2901-5AZ
K9Y
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/15
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Insert labels and insert caps
Inscription/Symbol
Symbol No.
DT Insert caps
For indicator lights
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
For self-inscription
Blank
B
3SB2901-7AA
100 10 units
102
Betrieb
B
3SB2901-7AP
100
1 unit
102
Störung
B
3SB2901-7AQ
100 10 units
102
With inscription
Graphic symbols
Pump
0134 ISO
B
3SB2901-7PD
100 10 units
102
Manual operation
0096 ISO
B
3SB2901-7QK
100 10 units
102
Customized inscriptions
Any inscription
3SB2901-7AZ
1 line of text with up to 6 characters of 3 mm in height.
Please add the appropriate order code to the Order No. and specify
the line of text required.
C
K0Y
1
1 unit
102
B
K1Y or K2Y
1
1 unit
102
B
K5Y
1
1 unit
102
Other graphic symbols
B
3SB2901-7AZ
1
1 unit
102
1
1 unit
102
Please add the order code "K3Y" to the Order No. and specify the
serial number and the applied standard (ISO 7000 or IEC 60417).
Any inscription or symbol
K3Y
B
Please add the order code "K9Y" to the Order No. and specify the
inscription or the symbol required.
3SB2901-7AZ
K9Y
■ Options
10
Customized inscriptions
Labels and caps can be inscribed with text and symbols not
listed in the ordering data. Append the following codes to the
Order No.:
• Text line in upper/lower case, always upper case for beginning
of line (e.g. "Lift"): K0Y
• Text line in upper case (e.g. "LIFT"): K1Y
• Text line in lower case (e.g. "lift"): K2Y
• Text line in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper case
letters (e.g. "Lift Out"): K5Y
• Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417:
K3Y
• Any inscription or symbols according to order form supplement: K9Y
When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in
addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German,
give the exact spelling and specify the language.
10/16
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
One line with up to 6 characters with 3 mm letter height is possible for the inscription (see ordering example 1).
Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to
ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3).
For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF
format can be submitted.
Ordering example 1
3SB29 01–4AZ
K1Y
Z = pump
Ordering example 2
3SB29 01–4AZ
K3Y
Z = 5008 IEC
Ordering example 3
3SB29 01–4AZ
K3Y
Z = 1118 ISO
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Name plates
■ Overview
The name plates consist of a black plastic label holder and an
inscription label (silver with black print) for sticking in place.
Inscriptions
The inscriptions (also special inscriptions) are lower case with
upper case initial letters. Graphic symbols, including those not
listed in the catalog, are according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417.
Note mounting dimensions!
■ Selection and ordering data
Inscription/Symbol
Symbol No.
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Inscription labels, self-adhesive, 9.5 mm × 18.5 mm
Blank
}
3SB2901-2AA
100 10 units
102
Ein
Aus
Auf
Zu
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-2AB
3SB2901-2AC
3SB2901-2AD
3SB2901-2AL
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
Vor
Zurück
Schnell
Langsam
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-2AF
3SB2901-2AG
3SB2901-2AM
3SB2901-2AN
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
Betrieb
Störung
Einrichten
B
B
B
3SB2901-2AP
3SB2901-2AQ
3SB2901-2AR
100 10 units
100 10 units
100 10 units
102
102
102
On
Off
Start
Reset
Fault
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2901-2EB
3SB2901-2EC
3SB2901-2EL
3SB2901-2EM
3SB2901-2EW
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
Hand Auto
Manual 0 Auto
Man 0 Auto
B
B
B
3SB2901-2BA
3SB2901-2BE
3SB2901-2ET
100 10 units
100 10 units
100 10 units
102
102
102
5008 IEC
B
3SB2901-2MB
100 10 units
102
I (On)
5007 IEC
B
3SB2901-2MC
100 10 units
102
O I (horizontal)
--
B
3SB2901-2MF
100 10 units
102
Motion in direction of arrow
5002 IEC
B
3SB2901-2NA
100 10 units
102
3SB29 01-2XZ
Customized inscriptions or symbols
(see Options)
C
K0Y
1
1 unit
102
B
K1Y, K2Y or K3Y
1
1 unit
102
B
K5Y
1
1 unit
102
B
K9Y
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB29 02-0AB
100 10 units
102
Label holders
Label holders for inscription labels
The label holders must not be used with the 3SB2...-1AC01
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton.
■ Options
Customized inscriptions
The labels can be inscribed with text and symbols not listed in
the ordering data. Append the following codes to the Order No.:
• Text line(s) in upper/lower case, upper case always for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift out"): K0Y
• Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OUT"): K1Y
• Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift out"): K2Y
• Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper
case letters (e.g. "Lift Out"): K5Y
• Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417:
K3Y
• Any inscription or symbols according to order form supplement: K9Y
When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in
addition to the order number and order code.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other
than German, give the exact spelling and specify the language.
Two lines of 11 characters are permitted with 4 mm letter height
(1 line) or 3 mm (2-line).
Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to
ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example).
For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF
format can be submitted.
Ordering example
3SB29 01–2XZ
K3Y
Z = 1118 ISO
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/17
10
Graphic symbols
O (Off)
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Mounting parts and components
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Lamp
voltage
Color
DT Order No.
Buttons, flat
For pushbuttons
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
Buttons, flat
For illuminated pushbuttons
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
Buttons, raised
For pushbuttons
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB2910-0AB
3SB2910-0AC
3SB2910-0AD
3SB2910-0AE
3SB2910-0AF
3SB2910-0AG
3SB2910-0AH
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2910-0CC
3SB2910-0CD
3SB2910-0CE
3SB2910-0CF
3SB2910-0AG
3SB2910-0AH
100
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Yellow
Clear
B
B
B
B
3SB2910-0BB
3SB2910-0BC
3SB2910-0BD
3SB2910-0BH
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
Buttons, raised
For illuminated pushbuttons
Red
Yellow
Clear
B
B
B
3SB2910-0DC
3SB2910-0DD
3SB2910-0BH
1 10 units
1 10 units
1 10 units
102
102
102
Screw lenses
With concentric rings
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2910-1AC
3SB2910-1AD
3SB2910-1AE
3SB2910-1AF
3SB2910-1AG
3SB2910-1AH
100
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
Screw lenses
Smooth, for inscription with insert cap
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
3SB2910-1BC
3SB2910-1BD
3SB2910-1BE
3SB2910-1BF
3SB2910-1BH
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
B
3SB2908-2AJ
1
1 unit
102
C
B
}
A
B
B
3SB2908-1AA
3SB2908-1AB
3SB2908-1AC
3SB2908-1AD
3SB2908-1AE
3SB2908-1AF
100
100
100
100
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
V
Buttons and lenses1)
3SB29 10-0AF
3SB29 10-0CF
3SB29 10-0BD
3SB29 10-0DD
3SB29 10-1AD
3SB29 10-1BE
10
Keys for actuators
Keys
For CES key-operated switch,
lock No. SB2
3SB29 08-2AJ
Lamps, Wedge bases2)
Incandescent lamps
Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d, 1.0 W
AC/DC
6
12
24
30
48
60
Clear
LED lamps, super-bright
Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d
24 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
White
Blue
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3901-1SB
3SB3901-1RB
3SB3901-1TB
3SB3901-1UB
3SB2908-1BD
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
28 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
White
Blue
B
B
B
B
D
3SB3901-1SE
3SB3901-1RE
3SB3901-1TE
3SB3901-1UE
3SB3901-1VE
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
}
3SB2908-2AB
1
1 unit
102
3SB29 08-1AE
3SB39 01-1SB
3SB29 08-1BD
Lamp extractors
For lamps with bases W2 × 4.6 d
3SB29 08-1AB
1)
Included in the scope of supply of actuators or indicator lights.
2)
Included in the scope of supply of some complete units.
10/18
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB2 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 16 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Mounting parts and components
Version
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Accessories for command points
Single frames for square design1)
}
3SB2902-0AA
100
10 units
102
Name plates, yellow, Ø 50 mm
As backing plate for EMERGENCY STOP, self-adhesive
• Blank
• With German inscription "NOT-HALT"
• With German inscription "NOT-AUS"
}
}
}
3SB2908-2AF
3SB2908-2AG
3SB2908-2AK
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Blanking plugs
Black plastic
(degree of protection IP65)
B
3SB2908-3AA
1
1 unit
102
Protective caps, clear
Silicone, for pushbuttons with flat and raised button
B
3SB2908-3AB
1
1 unit
102
Plug-in sleeves
For flat connectors 2.8 × 0.8 mm, cross-section 0.5 ... 1.5 mm2
A
3SB2908-8AA
100 250 units
102
Insulation sleeves
For flat connectors, connection from the front
D
3SB2908-8AB
100 250 units
102
Complete connectors2)
For connecting contact blocks and lampholders
(up to 10 connections).
Guaranteed finger-safe acc. to IEC 61140 and VBG 4.
B
3SB2908-8AD
1
1 unit
102
Plug-in sleeves
For flat connectors 2.8 × 0.8 mm,
with locating spring for latching in complete connector
B
3SB2908-8AE
100
10 units
102
Dismantling tools
For holders and lampholders with holder
}
3SB2908-2AA
1
1 unit
102
Mounting tools
For buttons
and screw lenses
}
3SB2908-2AC
1
1 unit
102
3SB29 02-0AA
T
T-HAL
NO
3SB29 08-2AG
3SB29 08-3AA
3SB29 08-1
Flat connectors
3SB29 08-8AA
3SB29 08-8AD
3SB29 08-8AE
Tools
3SB29 08-2AA
3SB29 08-2AC
Crimping tools for non-insulated connections,
type KRBC 0560
Art. No. 6179 0950
For plug-in sleeves (both versions)
E-mail: info@lappkabel.de
Lapp Kabel, Stuttgart
www.lappkabel.de
6179 0950
1)
Not suitable for EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons.
2)
Required 3SB29 08-8AE plug-in sleeves for flat connectors 2.8 × 0.8 mm
are not included in the scope of supply.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/19
10
3SB29 08-8AB
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
General data
■ Overview
Front plate mounting
D
C
B
E
D
A
F
NSD0_00029b
C
B
A
A
B
C
D
E
F
Actuator
Front plate
Holder
Contact block
Lampholder
Support element
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
Actuator
Front plate
Holder
Holder for printed circuit-board
Lampholder
Contact block
PCB
For actuators see page 10/25 to 10/62.
For contact blocks and lampholders see page 10/63 to 10/65.
For holders see page 10/67.
Used on printed circuit boards
G
F
E
10
D
C
NSD0_00030b
B
A
D
A
For contact blocks for use on printed circuit boards see page 10/67.
10/20
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
A
D
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
General data
Design
Standards
The 3SB3 series is a modular range of commanding and signaling devices for front panel mounting and rear conductor connection. As an alternative, individual elements can also be supplied
for use on printed circuit boards. Complete units are offered for
the most commonly used applications.
IEC 60947-1, EN 60947-1,
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1,
IEC 60947-5-5, EN 60947-5-5 for EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbuttons.
Connection methods
The devices are available with screw terminals (box terminals),
spring-type terminals or solder pins.
Screw terminals
Spring-type terminals
Solder pin connections
The terminals are indicated in the corresponding tables by the symbols shown on orange backgrounds.
■ Application
The 3SB3 series is available:
• Made of molded plastic in flat, round and square design
• Made of metal in round design.
The devices are of modern industrial design and can be
mounted rapidly by a single person. The operating surfaces of
the pushbuttons and illuminated pushbuttons are concave. The
lenses of the indicator lights are convex.
The metal version with a high degree of protection according to
IP67 and NEMA 4 is available for the world market.
One command point comprises:
• An actuator or lens assembly in front of the control panel
• A holder for mounting behind the control panel
• Up to 3 contact blocks and/or 1 lampholder behind the control
panel
• A comprehensive range of accessories for inscription
Two contact blocks can be snapped onto the actuator in the
standard version.
When three contact blocks or illuminated actuators are required,
an additional holder must be plugged onto the actuator from the
rear.
• 3SB39 01-0AB holder for 3 contact blocks or for 2 contact
blocks and 1 lampholder
• 3SB39 01-0AC holder with pressure plates for actuating a
central contact block when using a selector switch, key-operated switch and twin pushbutton with 3 contact blocks.
For illuminated pushbuttons, illuminated switches and illuminated selector switches the holder is included in the scope of
supply as standard.
The contact blocks are fitted with a slow-action contact (1 NO
contact or 1 NC contact) with double operating contacts. These
ensure a high switching reliability even with small voltages and
currents, such as 5 V/1 mA. They are suitable for use in solidstate systems as well as conventional controls.
The devices are climate-proof (KTW 24) and suitable for standard industrial applications and operation in marine applications. For operation in oily atmospheres (organic oils/lubricants)
we recommend actuators which are marked as "solventresistant".
AS-Interface solutions
The 3SB3 commanding and signaling devices can be connected to the AS-Interface communication system quickly and
safely with the help of various solutions.
The following solutions are available:
• ASIsafe EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons
(see page 10/68)
• AS-Interface enclosures with 1 to 6 command points
(see page 10/96).
• AS-Interface front panel modules for 4 command points
(see Catalog IK PI)
"Intrinsic safety" type of protection EEx i according to ATEX
directive 94/9/EC
The pushbuttons and indicator lights in round design can also
be used in hazardous areas. The 3SB34 ..-0. contact blocks and
the 3SB34 ..-1A lampholders (with 3SB39 01-1.A LED lamp) with
screw terminals or spring-type terminals can be used.
See Chapter 13 "Appendix" --> "Standards and Approvals" -->
"Ex Protection Certificates for SIRIUS Controls".
Safety EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons according to
ISO 13850
For controls according to IEC 60204-1 or EN 60204-1 (VDE 0113
Part 1), the mushroom pushbuttons of the 3SB3 series are suitable for use as safety EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons.
Safety circuits
IEC 60947-5-1 and EN 60947-5-1 require positive opening, i.e.
for the purposes of personal safety, the assured opening of NC
contacts is expressly stipulated for the electrical equipment of
machines in all safety circuits and marked according to
IEC 60947-5-1 with the symbol
.
Category 4 according to EN 954-1 can be attained with the
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons if the corresponding failsafe evaluation units are selected and correctly installed,
e.g. the 3TK28 safety relays or matching units from the ASIsafe,
SIMATIC or SINUMERIK product ranges.
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/21
10
Actuators and indicators and complete units
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
General data
■ Technical specifications
Type
3SB34 00-0, 3SB14 00-0J 3SB34 00-1, 3SB34 03-0, 3SB34 03-1, 3SB34 11-0
3SB34 20-0
3SB34 20-1 3SB34 23-0 3SB34 23-1
3SB34 11-1
Contact blocks and lampholders
Standards
IEC 60947-5-1, IEC 60947-5-5, EN 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-5
Connection type
Screw terminals
Spring-type terminals
Rated insulation voltage Ui
For pollution degree acc. to IEC 60947-1
V
400
Class 3
250
Class 3
400
Class 3
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp
Solder pins
250
Class 3
60
Class 3
kV
4
4
4
4
4
1.5
Conventional thermal current Ith
A
10
--
10
--
10
--
• Alternating current 50/60 Hz, AC-12
- At Ue = 24 ... 230 V
- At Ue = 400 V
A
A
10
10
10
----
10
10
10
----
10
10
--
---
• Alternating current 50/60 Hz, AC-15
- At Ue = 24 ... 230 V
- At Ue = 400 V
A
A
6
3
6
4
---
6
3
---
4
--
---
• Direct current DC-12
- At Ue = 24 V
- At Ue = 48 V
- At Ue = 110 V
- At Ue = 230 V
A
A
A
A
10
5
2.5
1
10
-2
0.5
-----
10
5
2.5
1
-----
10
5
2.5
1
-----
• Direct current DC-13
- At Ue = 24 V
- At Ue = 48 V
- At Ue = 110 V
- At Ue = 230 V
A
A
A
A
3
1.5
0.7
0.3
5
-0.5
0.2
-----
3
1.5
0.7
0.3
-----
3
1.5
0.7
0.3
-----
Contact stability
• Test voltage
• Test current
V
mA
5
1
---
5
1
---
5
1
---
Lampholders
--
BA 9s
--
BA 9s
--
Wedge
bases
Lamps
--
Incandescent lamps,
glow lamps
and LED
lamps
--
Incandescent lamps,
glow lamps
and LED
lamps
--
Incandescent lamps
and LED
lamps
10
Rated operational current Ie
at rated operational voltage Ue
Short-circuit protection, weld-free,
acc. to IEC 60947-5-1
• DIAZED fuse links,
utilization category gG acc. to IEC 60269-3-1
• DIAZED fuse links,
quick acc. to DIN VDE 0635
• Miniature circuit breaker with C characteristic
acc. to IEC 60898
Dz10 A
Dz 16 A
A
Mechanical endurance
10 × 106 operating cycles
Electrical endurance
• For utilization category AC-15 with 3RT20 15 to
3RT20 26 contactors
• With utilization category DC-12, DC-13
Switching frequency
10
10 × 106 operating cycles
With direct current it depends on the operational voltage, the breaking current, the circuit inductance
and the switching frequency
1/h
1000 operating cycles
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529
• Connections
• Contact chambers
IP20
IP40
Touch protection acc. to EN 61140 and BGV A3
Finger-safe
Finger-safe
--
--
IP40
--
IP40
Conductor cross-sections1)
• Finely stranded, without end sleeves
• Finely stranded, with end sleeves to DIN 46228
• Solid
• Solid with end sleeves to DIN 46228
• AWG cables, solid or stranded
mm2
mm2
mm2
mm2
-2 × (0.5 ... 1.5)
2 × (1 ... 1.5)
2 × (0.5 ... 0.75)
2 × AWG 18 ... 14
2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
2 × (0.25 ... 0.75)
2 × (0.25 ... 1.5)
-2 × AWG 24 ... 16
------
Tightening torque, terminal screw
Nm
0.8
--
--
Solder pins
mm2 --
--
0.8 × 0.8
1)
For standard screwdriver size 2 or Pozidriv 2.
10/22
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
--
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
General data
Type
3SB3400-0,
3SB3420-0
3SB3400-1,
3SB3420-1
3SB3403-0,
3SB3423-0
3SB3403-1,
3SB3423-1
3SB3411-0
3SB3411-1
--
300
--
300
--
--
10
--
10
--
Data according to UL and CSA
Rated operational voltage
V AC 300
Conventional thermal current (uninterrupted current) A
10
Switching capacity
A 300, R 300,
A 600 same polarity
Rated voltage (lamps)
• Lamp with BA 9s base
V AC --
125
--
125
--
--
• Lamp with wedge base
V AC --
60
--
60
--
60
• Lampholders with integrated LED
V
--
24 AC/DC,
110 AC,
230 AC
--
24 AC/DC,
110 AC,
230 AC
--
--
Rated power (lamps)
W
--
2.5
--
2.5
--
1
Type
3SB30, 3SB32, (3SB31)
3SB31, 3SB33
3SB35, 3SB36
Actuators and indicators
Enclosure material
Plastic
Design
Round
Terminal designation acc. to EN 50013
Identification number on the holder,
function digit on the contact block
Device identification
Snap-on label
Metal
Square
Round
Tightening torques
• Screw on holder
Nm
max. 1
Mechanical endurance
• Pushbuttons
10 × 106 operating cycles
• Illuminated pushbuttons
3 × 106 operating cycles
• Actuators, rotary or maintained contact
3 × 105 operating cycles
• Key-operated switch with key monitoring
1 × 105 operating cycles
Switching frequency
1/h
Climatic withstand capability acc. to EN ISO 6270-2
1000 operating cycles
Climate-proof KTW24;
suitable for marine applications
• During operation, non-illuminated and with LED
°C
–25 ... +70
• During operation, devices with incandescent lamp
°C
–25 ... +60
• During storage, transport
°C
–40 ... +80
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529
• Actuators and indicators, standard
IP66
IP65
IP67 and NEMA Type 4
IP67
IP67
--
• Key-operated switch with key monitoring
IP54
--
--
• Twin pushbuttons (3SB31)
IP65
--
--
Protective measures
Protective measures are met automatically when the actuators Grounding is necessary for
and lens assemblies are mounted on metal front plates and
operation with protective
enclosures.
extra-low voltage (PELV).
- With protective caps
When mounted in insulated enclosures, the "total insulation"
protective measures are met.
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
for half-sine shock type, 11 ms shock duration
• Devices without incandescent lamp
≤ 50 g
• Devices with incandescent lamp
≤ 30 g
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6
• Acceleration at frequency 20 ... 200 Hz
5g
Type
3SB380.-0, 3SB380.-1
--
3SB380.-2, 3SB380.-3
Enclosures
Enclosure material
Plastic
Metal
Actuators and indicators
Plastic, round
Metal, round
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529
IP65
IP67 and NEMA Type 4
Resistance to extreme climates acc. to DIN 50017
KTW 24
KTW 24
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/23
10
Ambient temperature
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
General data
Mounting depth
Configuration
The 3SB3 devices can be easily and quickly mounted:
• Actuators or indicator lights are positioned in the opening of
the front panel from the front
• Position the holder from the rear
• Tighten the screw on the holder
• Snap on the contact block or the lampholder directly onto the
actuator from the back
NSD0_00217
49
29
30
20
Pushbuttons with two contact blocks
For a switchboard thickness of 3 to 6 mm, the holder is reversed
and mounted in the direction of the arrow at ↑ 3–6 mm ↑ and the
fixing screw is located on the upper right. In this case, the fixing
screw must be rotated anticlockwise to its limit before mounting
the holder.
max. 24
The holder for the round versions is set to a switchboard thickness of 1 to 4 mm when delivered and is placed in the direction
of the arrow ↑ 1–4 mm ↑ on the actuator/indicator from the back.
The fixing screw is located underneath, on the right.
max. 24
Mounting and fixing
49
29
30
NSD0_00218
The control panel depth of 1 to 4 mm can be compensated with
the holder for the square version.
When label holders, protective caps or similar accessories are
used, the greatest permissible control panel thickness must be
reduced by the wall thickness of the accessory part.
10
30
Mounting dimensions on front plates
Illuminated pushbuttons with lampholder and two contact blocks
+0,2
29
a
b
Contact blocks (1 contact) and lampholder
• For front plate mounting, with screw terminals
• For front plate mounting with spring-type terminals
• For use on PCB, with solder pin connections
301)
301)
301)
45
301)
301)
Contact blocks with 2 contacts
• For front plate mounting
301)
50
NSD0_00220a
a
Minimum clearance
10
30
Illuminated pushbuttons with lampholder and two contact blocks with two
contacts
Used on printed circuit boards
452)
60
1)
For mushroom pushbutton, EMERGENCY-STOP and push-pull button:
Note mushroom diameter d = 40 mm or 60 mm.
2)
60 mm with contact blocks having two contacts.
NO 1
2
3
NSD0_00227b
4
min. 7.62
max. 10.16
min. 7,62,
max. 10,16
1
2
3
4
Solder pin 1.3 +0.1
PCB holder
+0.1
Centring hole 4.2
Lampholder
Illuminated pushbutton with solder pins
10/24
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
NC
5.08
301)
301)
15.24
20.32
When using holders for inscription labels
• 12.5 mm × 27 mm
• 27.0 mm × 27 mm
63
NSD0_00151
a
30
NSD0_00226a
a
45
10
a
b
b
NSD0_00150
Ø22,3 -0
max. 24
26,0 -0
+0,4
2.54
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
■ Selection and ordering data
The following applies to all complete units:
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Rated voltage of
lamp
Color of
handle
Contacts
for front plate
mounting
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
V
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Pushbuttons
Pushbuttons with flat button
--
Pushbutton with
flat button
Black
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
1 NO
1 NC
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
}
B
}
B
}
B
}
3SB3202-0AA11
3SB3203-0AA11
3SB3203-0AA21
3SB3202-0AA31
3SB3202-0AA41
3SB3202-0AA51
3SB3202-0AA61
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3202-0AA11-0CC0
3SB3203-0AA11-0CC0
3SB3203-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3202-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3202-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3202-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3202-0AA61-0CC0
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3201-0AA11
3SB3201-0AA21
3SB3201-0AA31
3SB3201-0AA41
3SB3201-0AA51
3SB3201-0AA61
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3201-0AA11-0CC0
3SB3201-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3201-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3201-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3201-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3201-0AA61-0CC0
Illuminated pushbutton
with flat button
1)
24 AC/DC
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3246-0AA21
3SB3245-0AA31
3SB3245-0AA41
3SB3245-0AA51
3SB3245-0AA61
3SB3245-0AA71
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3246-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3245-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3245-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3245-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3245-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3245-0AA71-0CC0
24 AC/DC
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3247-0AA21
3SB3247-0AA31
3SB3247-0AA41
3SB3247-0AA51
3SB3247-0AA61
3SB3247-0AA71
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3247-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3247-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3247-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3247-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3247-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3247-0AA71-0CC0
110 AC
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3250-0AA21
3SB3257-0AA31
3SB3257-0AA41
3SB3257-0AA51
3SB3257-0AA61
3SB3257-0AA71
-------
110 AC
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
C
B
B
3SB3251-0AA21
3SB3251-0AA31
3SB3251-0AA41
3SB3251-0AA51
3SB3251-0AA61
3SB3251-0AA71
-------
230 AC
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3254-0AA21
3SB3253-0AA31
3SB3253-0AA41
3SB3253-0AA51
3SB3253-0AA61
3SB3253-0AA71
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3254-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3253-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3253-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3253-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3253-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3253-0AA71-0CC0
230 AC
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3255-0AA21
3SB3255-0AA31
3SB3255-0AA41
3SB3255-0AA51
3SB3255-0AA61
3SB3255-0AA71
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3255-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3255-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3255-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3255-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3255-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3255-0AA71-0CC0
10
Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button
with integrated LED (incl. holder for 3 elements)
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/25
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Color of handle
Contacts
for front plate
mounting
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Pushbuttons
Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button
With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Illuminated pushbutton
with flat button
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3207-0AA21
3SB3206-0AA31
3SB3206-0AA41
3SB3206-0AA51
3SB3206-0AA61
3SB3206-0AA71
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3207-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3206-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3206-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3206-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3206-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3206-0AA71-0CC0
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3205-0AA21
3SB3205-0AA31
3SB3205-0AA41
3SB3205-0AA51
3SB3205-0AA61
3SB3205-0AA71
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3205-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3205-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3205-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3205-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3205-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3205-0AA71-0CC0
1 NC
}
3SB3203-1CA21
B
3SB3203-1CA21-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC
B
3SB3201-1CA21
B
3SB3201-1CA21-0CC0
Mushroom pushbuttons
Mushroom push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching
With pull-to-unlatch mechanism
Red
Mushroom push-pull
button
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
10
1)
10/26
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Version
Color of
handle/
Lock No.
Contacts
for front plate
mounting
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Selector switches
Selector switches, 2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle
Latching
Black
1 NO
}
3SB3202-2KA11
B
3SB3202-2KA11-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC
B
3SB3201-2KA11
B
3SB3201-2KA11-0CC0
1 NO
B
3SB3202-2HA11
--
1 NO + 1 NC
B
3SB3201-2HA11
--
1 NO, 1 NO
}
3SB3210-2DA11
B
3SB3210-2DA11-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC,
1 NO + 1 NC
B
3SB3208-2DA11
B
3SB3208-2DA11-0CC0
1 NO, 1 NO
B
3SB3210-2EA11
B
3SB3210-2EA11-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC,
1 NO + 1 NC
B
3SB3208-2EA11
C
3SB3208-2EA11-0CC0
Selector switches, 2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I, 90° operating angle
Latching
Black
Selector switch
Selector switches, 3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle
Latching
Momentary
contact type
Black
Black
Key-operated switches
RONIS key-operated switches,
2 switch positions
With 2 keys, removal position O + I,
switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle
Latching
SB 30
1 NO
}
3SB3202-4AD11
B
3SB3202-4AD11-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC
B
3SB3201-4AD11
B
3SB3201-4AD11-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC,
1 NO + 1 NC
D
3SB3100-8AC61
10
RONIS key-operated
switch
Twin pushbuttons
Twin pushbuttons
With flat, square buttons1)
With I/O
inscription
White/White
--
Twin pushbutton
with flat buttons
1)
Mounting the twin pushbuttons in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible.
For accessories, see page 10/41.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/27
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Color of handle
DT Screw terminals
Contacts
for front plate
mounting
Order No.
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850,
with yellow name plate, Ø 80 mm, with inscription
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons,
Ø 40 mm, with positive latching function
With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism
• German inscription
"NOT-HALT"
Red
1 NC
1)
}
3SB3203-1HA20
B
3SB3203-1HA20-0CC0
Red
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3201-1HA20
B
3SB3201-1HA20-0CC0
• English inscription
"EMERGENCY STOP"
With rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism
Red
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3203-1HR20
--
Red
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3201-1HR20
--
• French inscription
"ARRET D’URGENCE"
Red
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3203-1HP20
--
Red
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3201-1HP20
--
With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism and mechanical
switch position indication
• German inscription
"NOT-HALT"
Red
1 NC
1)
}
3SB3203-1HA26
B
3SB3203-1HA26-0CC0
Red
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3201-1HA26
B
3SB3201-1HA26-0CC0
• English inscription
"EMERGENCY STOP"
With rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism and switch
position indication
Red
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3203-1HR26
--
Red
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3201-1HR26
--
With pull-to-unlatch mechanism
10
• German inscription
"NOT-HALT"
Red
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3203-1TA20
--
Red
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3201-1TA20
--
• English inscription
"EMERGENCY STOP"
With pull-to-unlatch
mechanism
1)
Red
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3203-1TR20
--
Red
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3201-1TR20
--
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
Can be used with 3TK28 safety relays.
Certificate:
10/28
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Rated voltage of lamp
Color of lens
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
V
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Indicator lights
Indicator lights with smooth lens1)
With integrated LED
24 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3244-6AA20
3SB3244-6AA30
3SB3244-6AA40
3SB3244-6AA50
3SB3244-6AA60
3SB3244-6AA70
110 AC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3248-6AA20
3SB3248-6AA30
3SB3248-6AA40
3SB3248-6AA50
3SB3248-6AA60
3SB3248-6AA70
230 AC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3252-6AA20
3SB3252-6AA30
3SB3252-6AA40
3SB3252-6AA50
3SB3252-6AA60
3SB3252-6AA70
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3252-6AA20-0CC0
3SB3252-6AA30-0CC0
3SB3252-6AA40-0CC0
3SB3252-6AA50-0CC0
3SB3252-6AA60-0CC0
3SB3252-6AA70-0CC0
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3204-6AA20
3SB3204-6AA30
3SB3204-6AA40
3SB3204-6AA50
3SB3204-6AA60
3SB3204-6AA70
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3204-6AA20-0CC0
3SB3204-6AA30-0CC0
3SB3204-6AA40-0CC0
3SB3204-6AA50-0CC0
3SB3204-6AA60-0CC0
3SB3204-6AA70-0CC0
24 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3244-6BA20
3SB3244-6BA30
3SB3244-6BA40
3SB3244-6BA50
3SB3244-6BA60
3SB3244-6BA70
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3244-6BA20-0CC0
3SB3244-6BA30-0CC0
3SB3244-6BA40-0CC0
3SB3244-6BA50-0CC0
3SB3244-6BA60-0CC0
3SB3244-6BA70-0CC0
110 AC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3248-6BA20
3SB3248-6BA30
3SB3248-6BA40
3SB3248-6BA50
3SB3248-6BA60
3SB3248-6BA70
230 AC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3252-6BA20
3SB3252-6BA30
3SB3252-6BA40
3SB3252-6BA50
3SB3252-6BA60
3SB3252-6BA70
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3252-6BA20-0CC0
3SB3252-6BA30-0CC0
3SB3252-6BA40-0CC0
3SB3252-6BA50-0CC0
3SB3252-6BA60-0CC0
3SB3252-6BA70-0CC0
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3204-6BA00
3SB3204-6BA20
3SB3204-6BA30
3SB3204-6BA40
3SB3204-6BA50
3SB3204-6BA60
3SB3204-6BA70
B
B
B
B
B
B
-3SB3204-6BA20-0CC0
3SB3204-6BA30-0CC0
3SB3204-6BA40-0CC0
3SB3204-6BA50-0CC0
3SB3204-6BA60-0CC0
3SB3204-6BA70-0CC0
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3240-6BA00
3SB3240-6BA20
3SB3240-6BA30
3SB3240-6BA40
3SB3240-6BA50
3SB3240-6BA60
3SB3240-6BA70
Indicator light with smooth
lens
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3244-6AA20-0CC0
3SB3244-6AA30-0CC0
3SB3244-6AA40-0CC0
3SB3244-6AA50-0CC0
3SB3244-6AA60-0CC0
3SB3244-6AA70-0CC0
-------
With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp
--
Indicator lights with lens
with concentric rings1)
With integrated LED
10
Indicator light with lens
with concentric rings
-------
With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp
--
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
With BA 9s lampholder, with LED
130 AC
1)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
--------
Inscription by inserting a label is not possible.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/29
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
Version
Rated voltage Color of
of lamp
lens
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
V
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Signaling devices
Acoustic signaling devices, IP651)
Continuous tone 2.4 kHz,
24 AC/DC
operational current min. 4 mA, 115 AC/DC
sound pressure
230 AC/DC
min. 80 dB/10 cm
X1
(L+)
3SB3233-7BA10
3SB3234-7BA10
3SB3235-7BA10
Black
A
B
A
Color of
handle
DT Without connection
X2
(L-)
NSD00003
Acoustic signaling device
1)
Mounting in 3SB38 enclosure only with 3SB3400-1A lampholder;
not possible with 3SB3420-1A lampholder for floor mounting.
Version
Degree of
protection
Order No.
Price
per PU
Special devices
Drives for potentiometers2)3)
With shaft Ø 6 mm,
30 ... 32 mm long
IP65
B
3SB1000-7CH07
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3000-0EA11
1
1 unit
102
Potentiometer drive
Pushbuttons with extended stroke2)
For actuating relays
IP65
Black
10
12 mm stroke
Pushbutton with
12 mm stroke
2)
Mounting in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible.
3)
The potentiometer is not included in the scope of supply.
10/30
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Coordinate switches, complete
■ Overview
Operation
The 3SB14 00-0J contact block is used, which due to its depth
cannot be built into 3SB38 enclosures.
Switches are available as follows:
• With 2 or 4 switch positions
• Latching or momentary contact type
• With or without mechanical interlocking
In the case of switches with mechanical interlock in O position,
the switch is unlatched with the unlatching button at the front of
the actuating lever.
Inscriptions
A name plate consisting of a black, plastic label holder and two
or four adhesive, silver-colored inscription labels of
27 mm x 27 mm in size is available for labeling purposes. These
labels can be supplied with and without customized inscription.
Note mounting dimensions!
Coordinate switch with contact blocks
Joystick switches control auxiliary circuits permitting movements in various directions of machines and equipment.
The switches are designed for front panel mounting. They are
climate-proof.
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
DT Screw terminals
Operating travel
Contact closed
Contact open
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Coordinate switches
2 switch positions, 1 NO per direction
Horizontal, momentary contact type
NSD01077
A 0 B
NSD01079
A
B
43-44
33-34
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1201-7DV01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1201-7DV20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1201-7DW01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1201-7DW20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1201-7FV01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1201-7FV20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1201-7FW01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1201-7FW20
1
1 unit
102
With mechanical locking in the O position
Coordinate switch,
2 switch positions
Vertical, momentary contact type
NSD01078
NSD01080
D
0
C
13-14
23-24
D
C
0
Without mechanical locking in the O position
With mechanical locking in the O position
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/31
10
0
Without mechanical locking in the O position
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Coordinate switches, complete
Version
DT Screw terminals
Operating travel
Contact closed
Contact open
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Coordinate switches
2 switch positions, 1 NO per direction
Horizontal, latching
NSD01077
A 0 B
NSD01079
A
B
43-44
33-34
0
Without mechanical locking in the O position
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1201-7EV01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1201-7EV20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1201-7EW01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1201-7EW20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1201-7GV01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1201-7GV20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1201-7GW01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1201-7GW20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1208-7JV01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1208-7JV20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1208-7JW01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1208-7JW20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1208-7KV01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1208-7KV20
1
1 unit
102
• With plastic front ring, black
B
3SB1208-7KW01
1
1 unit
102
• With metal front ring
B
3SB1208-7KW20
1
1 unit
102
With mechanical locking in the O position
Coordinate switch,
2 switch positions
Vertical, latching
NSD01078
NSD01080
D
0
C
13-14
23-24
D
C
0
Without mechanical locking in the O position
With mechanical locking in the O position
4 switch positions, 1 NO per direction
Momentary contact type
D
A 0 B
C
43-44
33-34
A
B
13-14
23-24
D
C
NSD00076
10
0
Coordinate switch,
4 switch positions
NSD00077
Without mechanical locking in the O position
With mechanical locking in the O position
Latching
D
A 0 B
C
43-44
33-34
A
B
NSD00076
13-14
23-24
D
C
0
NSD00077
Without mechanical locking in the O position
With mechanical locking in the O position
10/32
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Coordinate switches, complete
■ Accessories
Version
Contact blocks
DT Screw terminals
Symbols/
operating travel
Contact closed
Contact open
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
1
1 unit
102
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Spare contact blocks
(in scope of supply of
switch)
.3 .3
.4 .4
C
NSD00104
Contact blocks with
2 contacts
1 NO, 1 NO
A
B
.3/.4
.3/.4
NSD00109a
0
3SB14 00-0J
3SB1400-0J
Version
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
Name plates
Label holders for joystick switches
2 switch positions, horizontal, 89 mm × 30 mm
B
3SB1906-0AU
1
1 unit
102
2 switch positions, vertical, 30 mm × 89 mm
B
3SB1906-0AV
1
1 unit
102
4 switch positions
B
3SB1906-0AW
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB1906-2AA
100 10 units
102
Inscription labels 27 mm × 27 mm,
silver-colored, for sticking in place
Without inscription
3SB1906-2XZ
With inscription (engraved)
D
K0Y, K1Y, K2Y, or
K5Y
1
1 unit
102
• Graphic symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or
IEC 60417
D
K3Y
1
1 unit
102
• Any inscription or symbol
D
K9Y
1
1 unit
102
10
3SB19 06-0AV
• Text lines (up to 5 lines each with 11 characters)
3SB19 06-0AW
For black plastic labels, see page 10/74.
■ Options
Customized inscriptions
These labeling plates can be inscribed with text or symbols.
5 lines with 11 characters each in a letter height of 4 mm are
possible.
Ordering notes
Append the following codes to the Order No.:
• Text line(s) in upper/lower case, upper case always for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift off"): K0Y
• Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): K1Y
• Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): K2Y
• Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper
case letters (e.g. "Lift Off"): K5Y
• Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417:
K3Y
• Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: K9Y
When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in
addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German,
give the exact spelling and specify the language.
In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned
to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower".
Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to
ISO 7000 or IEC 60417.
For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF
format can be submitted.
Ordering example
A label inscribed with symbol No. 1117 according to ISO 7000 is
required:
3SB19 06-2XZ
K3Y
Z = 1117 ISO
For other ordering examples see page 10/77.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/33
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Inscriptions
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Gray
Clear2)
}
}
B
}
B
}
B
B
Green
Red
White
Black
Blue
Pushbuttons
with raised button
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3000-0AA11
3SB3000-0AA21
3SB3000-0AA31
3SB3000-0AA41
3SB3000-0AA51
3SB3000-0AA61
3SB3000-0AB51
3SB3000-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3000-0AA81
3SB3000-0AB01
3SB3000-0AB11
3SB3000-0AB21
3SB3000-0AC81
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3000-0BA11
3SB3000-0BA21
3SB3000-0BA31
3SB3000-0BA41
3SB3000-0BA51
3SB3000-0BA61
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with raised button,
latching by pressing in and
turning to the right,
unlatches by turning to the left
Black
Red
}
B
3SB3000-0CA11
3SB3000-0CA21
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
Pushbuttons
with raised front ring
(height 13 mm)
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3000-0AA12
3SB3000-0AA22
3SB3000-0AA32
3SB3000-0AA42
3SB3000-0AA52
3SB3000-0AA62
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with raised front ring,
castellated
(height 13 mm)
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
B
B
B
B
3SB3000-0AA13
3SB3000-0AA23
3SB3000-0AA33
3SB3000-0AA43
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with flat button
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Amber2)
Red2)
Yellow2)
Green2)
Blue2)
White
Clear2)
C
}
}
}
B
B
}
3SB3001-0AA01
3SB3001-0AA21
3SB3001-0AA31
3SB3001-0AA41
3SB3001-0AA51
3SB3001-0AA61
3SB3001-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with raised button
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-0BA21
3SB3001-0BA31
3SB3001-0BA41
3SB3001-0BA51
3SB3001-0BA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with flat button,
latching, unlatches by
pressing again
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Gray
B
B
B
B
B
B
C
3SB3000-0DA11
3SB3000-0DA21
3SB3000-0DA31
3SB3000-0DA41
3SB3000-0DA51
3SB3000-0DA61
3SB3000-0DB51
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with flat button,
latching, unlatches by
pressing again
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Red2)
Yellow2)
Green2)
Blue2)
White
Clear2)
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-0DA21
3SB3001-0DA31
3SB3001-0DA41
3SB3001-0DA51
3SB3001-0DA61
3SB3001-0DA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons with holder1)
Pushbuttons
with flat button
I
O
I
O
R
With flat button
With raised button
10
With raised button,
latching
With raised front ring
With raised front ring,
castellated
Illuminated pushbutton
with raised button
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
10/34
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 30 mm
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
B
B
B
B
Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3000-1DA11
3SB3000-1DA21
3SB3000-1DA31
3SB3000-1DA41
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
}
}
B
B
3SB3000-1GA11
3SB3000-1GA21
3SB3000-1GA31
3SB3000-1GA41
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
B
B
B
B
3SB3000-1QA11
3SB3000-1QA21
3SB3000-1QA31
3SB3000-1QA41
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons,
Ø 30 mm
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-1DA21
3SB3001-1DA31
3SB3001-1DA41
3SB3001-1DA51
3SB3001-1DA61
3SB3001-1DA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons,
Ø 40 mm
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Yellow
Green
White
B
B
B
3SB3001-1GA31
3SB3001-1GA41
3SB3001-1GA61
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 30 mm, latching,
pull to unlatch
Black
Red
B
B
3SB3000-1EA11
3SB3000-1EA21
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching,
pull to unlatch
Black
Red
}
}
3SB3000-1CA11
3SB3000-1CA21
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 60 mm, latching,
pull to unlatch
Black
Red
B
B
3SB3000-1RA11
3SB3000-1RA21
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 30 mm, can be
illuminated, latching, pull to unlatch,
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-1EA21
3SB3001-1EA31
3SB3001-1EA41
3SB3001-1EA51
3SB3001-1EA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, can be
illuminated, latching, pull to unlatch
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-1CA21
3SB3001-1CA31
3SB3001-1CA41
3SB3001-1CA51
3SB3001-1CA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
2)
Maximum permissible equipment: 3 single-pole or 2 double-pole contact
blocks. When using the 3SB39 01-0AB holder, the central command point
must not be empty.
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/35
10
Mushroom pushbuttons with holder1)2)
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Version
Illumination
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Black
Red
Green
White
B
B
B
B
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
Nonilluminated
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3000-2HA11
3SB3000-2HA21
3SB3000-2HA41
3SB3000-2HA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-2HA21
3SB3001-2HA31
3SB3001-2HA41
3SB3001-2HA51
3SB3001-2HA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB3000-2KA11
3SB3000-2KA21
3SB3000-2KA41
3SB3000-2KA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-2KA21
3SB3001-2KA31
3SB3001-2KA41
3SB3001-2KA51
3SB3001-2KA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Nonilluminated
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB3000-2LA11
3SB3000-2LA21
3SB3000-2LA41
3SB3000-2LA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-2LA21
3SB3001-2LA31
3SB3001-2LA41
3SB3001-2LA51
3SB3001-2LA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB3000-2DA11
3SB3000-2DA21
3SB3000-2DA41
3SB3000-2DA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-2DA21
3SB3001-2DA31
3SB3001-2DA41
3SB3001-2DA51
3SB3001-2DA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Nonilluminated
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB3000-2EA11
3SB3000-2EA21
3SB3000-2EA41
3SB3000-2EA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-2EA21
3SB3001-2EA31
3SB3001-2EA41
3SB3001-2EA51
3SB3001-2EA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB3000-2GA11
3SB3000-2GA21
3SB3000-2GA41
3SB3000-2GA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-2GA21
3SB3001-2GA31
3SB3001-2GA41
3SB3001-2GA51
3SB3001-2GA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Green
White
B
B
B
B
3SB3000-2FA11
3SB3000-2FA21
3SB3000-2FA41
3SB3000-2FA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
C
B
3SB3001-2FA21
3SB3001-2FA31
3SB3001-2FA41
3SB3001-2FA51
3SB3001-2FA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Selector switches with holder1)
Selector switches with 2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I,
90° operating angle,
latching
Non-illuminated
Switching sequence O-I,
50° operating angle,
latching
Switching sequence O-I,
50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
Illuminated
Nonilluminated
Selector switches with 3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II,
Non2 x 50° operating angle,
illuminated
latching
10
Non-illuminated
Illuminated
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
NonSwitching sequence I-O-II,
illuminated
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type to the
left, latching to the right
NonSwitching sequence I-O-II,
illuminated
2 x 50° operating angle,
latching to the left, momentary
contact type to the right
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
10/36
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Lock version
Type
DT Order No.
Lock No./ Key
color
removal
position
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Key-operated switches with holder1)
Switching sequence O-I, RONIS
50° operating angle,
latching
SB 30
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3000-4HD11
3SB3000-4HD01
3SB3000-4HD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Switching sequence O-I, RONIS
50° operating angle,
RONIS key-operated switch latching
CES
SB 30
O+I
O
I
}
}
B
3SB3000-4AD11
3SB3000-4AD01
3SB3000-4AD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
SSG 10
O+I
O
I
}
}
B
3SB3000-4LD11
3SB3000-4LD01
3SB3000-4LD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
LSG 1
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3000-4LF01
3SB3000-4LF11
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
CES with key SSG 10
monitoring2)
O
C
3SB3000-4LD05
1
1 unit
102
BKS
S1
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3000-5AD11
3SB3000-5AD01
3SB3000-5AD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
E1 for
VW3)
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3000-5AE01
3SB3000-5AE11
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
E2 for
VW3)
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3000-5AE21
3SB3000-5AE31
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
E7 for
VW3)
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3000-5AE41
3SB3000-5AE51
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
E9 for
VW3)
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3000-5AE61
3SB3000-5AE71
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
73038
O+I
Light blue O
B
B
3SB3000-3AG11
3SB3000-3AG01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
73037
Red
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3000-3AH11
3SB3000-3AH01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
73034
Black
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3000-3AJ11
3SB3000-3AJ01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
73033
Yellow
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3000-3AK11
3SB3000-3AK01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
CES key-operated switch
O.M.R.4)
BKS key-operated switch
Switching sequence O-I, RONIS
50° operating angle,
CES
momentary contact type
O.M.R. key-operated switch
SB 30
O
}
3SB3000-4BD01
1
1 unit
102
SSG 10
O
}
3SB3000-4MD01
1
1 unit
102
LSG 1
O
B
3SB3000-4MF11
1
1 unit
102
BKS
S1
O
B
3SB3000-5BD01
1
1 unit
102
O.M.R.4)
73038
O
Light blue
B
3SB3000-3BG01
1
1 unit
102
73037
Red
O
B
3SB3000-3BH01
1
1 unit
102
73034
Black
O
B
3SB3000-3BJ01
1
1 unit
102
73033
Yellow
O
B
3SB3000-3BK01
1
1 unit
102
For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69.
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
For locks with key monitoring the supplied 3SB39 01-0AB holder must be
used.
The key scan is performed by a 3SB34 single-pole NC contact block which
must be snap-mounted in the center position. Scanning of the switch positions must be performed by additional contact blocks which are snapmounted on the actuator.
Special locks can be ordered only with order code "Y01".
3)
Keys are not included in scope of supply.
4)
According to FIAT standards; also available for other users.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/37
10
Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 2 switch positions
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Lock version
Type
DT Order No.
Lock No./ Key
color
removal
position
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Key-operated switches with holder1)
Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 3 switch positions
SB 30
I+O+II
O
I+II
I
II
O+I
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3000-4DD11
3SB3000-4DD01
3SB3000-4DD41
3SB3000-4DD21
3SB3000-4DD31
3SB3000-4DD51
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
SSG 10
I+O+II
O
O+I
I+II
I
II
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3000-4PD11
3SB3000-4PD01
3SB3000-4PD51
3SB3000-4PD41
3SB3000-4PD21
3SB3000-4PD31
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
CES with key SSG 10
monitoring2)
O
C
3SB3000-4PD05
1
1 unit
102
BKS
S1
I+O+II
II
B
C
3SB3000-5DD11
3SB3000-5DD31
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
O.M.R.3)
73038
I+O+II
Light blue O
B
B
3SB3000-3DG11
3SB3000-3DG01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
73037
Red
O
O+I
B
B
3SB3000-3DH01
3SB3000-3DH51
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
73034
Black
I+O+II
O
B
B
3SB3000-3DJ11
3SB3000-3DJ01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
73033
Yellow
I+O+II
B
3SB3000-3DK11
1
1 unit
102
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
2 x 50° operating angle,
latching
CES
RONIS key-operated switch
CES key-operated switch
SB 30
O
B
3SB3000-4ED01
1
1 unit
102
SSG 10
O
B
3SB3000-4QD01
1
1 unit
102
S1
O
B
3SB3000-5ED01
1
1 unit
102
73034
Black
O
B
3SB3000-3EJ01
1
1 unit
102
SB 30
O + II
O
II
B
B
B
3SB3000-4GD61
3SB3000-4GD01
3SB3000-4GD31
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
SSG 10
O + II
O
B
B
3SB3000-4SD61
3SB3000-4SD01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
S1
O
B
3SB3000-5GD01
1
1 unit
102
SB 30
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3000-4FD51
3SB3000-4FD01
3SB3000-4FD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
SSG 10
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3000-4RD51
3SB3000-4RD01
3SB3000-4RD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
BKS
S1
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3000-5FD51
3SB3000-5FD01
3SB3000-5FD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
O.M.R.3)
73038
O
Light blue
B
3SB3000-3FG01
1
1 unit
102
73034
Black
B
3SB3000-3FJ21
1
1 unit
102
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
2 x 50° operating angle,
CES
momentary contact type
BKS
O.M.R.3)
BKS key-operated switch
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type to
the left,
CES
latching to the right
10
BKS
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
2 x 50° operating angle,
latching to the left,
O.M.R. key-operated switch momentary contact type to CES
the right
I
For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69.
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
For locks with key monitoring the supplied 3SB39 01-0AB holder must be
used.
The key scan is performed by a 3SB34 single-pole NC contact block which
must be snap-mounted in the center position. Scanning of the switch positions must be performed by additional contact blocks which are snapmounted on the actuator.
Special locks can be ordered only with order code "Y01".
3)
According to FIAT standards; also available for other users.
10/38
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Color of
handle
Approval
DT Order No.
Price PU (UNIT,
per PU
SET, M)
PS*
PG
EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850 and IEC 60947-5-5, with
holder1)2). Can also be used with 3TK28 safety relays.
B
3SB3000-1FA20
1
1 unit
102
• Without switch position indicator
}
3SB3000-1HA20
1
1 unit
102
• With mechanical switch position
indication
A
3SB3000-1HA26
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 32 mm
With positive latching
according to ISO 13850,
with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism
Red
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm
With positive latching according to
ISO 13850, with rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism
Red
Mushroom diameter 32 mm
Mushroom diameter 40 mm,
with rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism with switch
position indication
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm
With positive latching according to
ISO 13850, with pull-to-unlatch
mechanism
Red
B
3SB3000-1TA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm
With positive latching according to
ISO 13850, with rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism
Red
B
3SB3000-1AA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with RONIS key-operated switch,
lock No. SB 30,
with positive latching according to
ISO 13850,
unlocking only possible using key
Red
B
3SB3000-1BA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with CES key-operated switch,
lock No. SSG 10,
with positive latching according to
ISO 13850,
unlocking only possible using key
Red
B
3SB3000-1KA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with BKS key-operated switch,
lock No. S1,
with positive latching according to
ISO 13850,
unlocking only possible using key
Red
B
3SB3000-1LA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with O.M.R. key-operated switch,
Mushroom diameter 40 mm, lock No. 73037,
with CES key-operated switch with positive latching according to
ISO 13850,
unlocking only possible using key
Red
B
3SB3000-1MA20
1
1 unit
102
10
Mushroom diameter 40 mm,
pull-to-unlatch mechanism
Mushroom diameter 60 mm
Mushroom diameter 40 mm,
with RONIS key-operated
switch
For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69.
1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
The yellow backing plates must be ordered separately, see Accessories.
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/39
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Color of lens DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Signaling elements with holder1)
Indicator light with
concentric rings
Indicator lights
With smooth lens2)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3001-6AA00
3SB3001-6AA20
3SB3001-6AA30
3SB3001-6AA40
3SB3001-6AA50
3SB3001-6AA60
3SB3001-6AA70
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Indicator lights
With lens with concentric rings2)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3001-6BA00
3SB3001-6BA20
3SB3001-6BA30
3SB3001-6BA40
3SB3001-6BA50
3SB3001-6BA60
3SB3001-6BA70
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Acoustic signaling devices, IP403)
For acoustic signal transformer 24 V DC4)
(without BA 9s base)
Black
B
3SB3000-7AA10
1
1 unit
102
Acoustic signaling device
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
Inscription by inserting a label is not possible.
3)
For acoustic signaling devices, IP65, see Complete Units.
Version
Inscriptions
4)
To order 3SB1902-2BN acoustic signal transformers separately, see
Accessories.
The 3SB34 00-1A lampholder is also required; only version with screw terminals can be used. With front mounting, use in the enclosure is also
possible.
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Twin pushbuttons with indicator light with holder1)2)
I/O3)
I/O3)
Green/Red
White/Black
B
B
3SB3101-8BC21
3SB3101-8BC31
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
↑/↓3)
Green/Red
D
3SB3101-8BC81
1
1 unit
102
Twin pushbuttons with
indicator light
With flat and raised,
square buttons,
incl. holder for 3 elements
I/O3)
I/O3)
Green/Red
White/Black
B
B
3SB3101-8DC21
3SB3101-8DC31
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
10
Twin pushbuttons with
indicator light
With flat, square buttons,
incl. holder for 3 elements
Twin pushbutton
with indicator light,
with flat buttons
Twin pushbutton
with indicator light,
with flat and
raised buttons
1)
Mounting the twin pushbuttons in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible.
2)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
3)
Black inscription for green, red and white buttons;
white inscription on black button.
10/40
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Inscriptions
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Twin pushbuttons
With flat, square buttons
I/O3)
I/O3)
Green/Red
White/Black
B
B
3SB3100-8AC21
3SB3100-8AC31
↑/↓3)
White/White
B
3SB3100-8AC61-0AD0
Twin pushbuttons
With flat and raised,
square buttons
I/O3)
I/O3)
Green/Red
White/Black
B
B
3SB3100-8CC21
3SB3100-8CC31
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
100 10 units
102
Twin pushbuttons with holder1)2)
Twin pushbutton
with flat buttons
1)
Mounting the twin pushbuttons in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible.
2)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
3)
Black inscription for green, red and white buttons;
white inscription on black button.
Version
Use
DT Order No.
Label holders 70 mm x 30 mm
For inscription label
12.5 mm x 27 mm1)
Twin pushbuttons
B
3SB3922-0AY
Protective caps, clear
Silicone, for degree of protection IP67
Twin pushbuttons
with flat buttons
B
3SB3921-0AQ
Price
per PU
Accessories for twin pushbuttons
1
1 unit
102
Protective cap
1)
Mounting in 3SB38 enclosure is not possible.
For blank labels see pages 10/73 and 10/74.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/41
10
Label holder
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm
Complete units
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Rated
voltage of
lamp
Color of Contacts for DT Screw terminals
handle front plate
mounting
Order No.
V
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Pushbuttons
Pushbuttons
with flat button
--
Pushbutton
Illuminated
pushbuttons
with flat button
With integrated LED
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
24 AC/DC
Illuminated pushbutton
Illuminated
pushbuttons
with flat button
With integrated LED
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
10
Illuminated
pushbuttons
with flat button
With BA 9s lampholder
without lamp
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
1)
230 AC
Black
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
1 NO
1 NC
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3302-0AA11
3SB3303-0AA11
3SB3303-0AA21
3SB3302-0AA31
3SB3302-0AA41
3SB3302-0AA51
3SB3302-0AA61
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
C
B
3SB3301-0AA11
3SB3301-0AA21
3SB3301-0AA31
3SB3301-0AA41
3SB3301-0AA51
3SB3301-0AA61
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3346-0AA21
3SB3345-0AA31
3SB3345-0AA41
3SB3345-0AA51
3SB3345-0AA61
3SB3345-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3347-0AA21
3SB3347-0AA31
3SB3347-0AA41
3SB3347-0AA51
3SB3347-0AA61
3SB3347-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
B
C
B
C
B
B
3SB3354-0AA21
3SB3353-0AA31
3SB3353-0AA41
3SB3353-0AA51
3SB3353-0AA61
3SB3353-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
C
B
C
C
B
3SB3355-0AA21
3SB3355-0AA31
3SB3355-0AA41
3SB3355-0AA51
3SB3355-0AA61
3SB3355-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3307-0AA21
3SB3306-0AA31
3SB3306-0AA41
3SB3306-0AA51
3SB3306-0AA61
3SB3306-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3305-0AA21
3SB3305-0AA31
3SB3305-0AA41
3SB3305-0AA51
3SB3305-0AA61
3SB3305-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
10/42
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm
Complete units
Version
Color of
handle
DT Screw terminals
Contacts for
front plate
mounting
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
EMERGENCY-STOP devices acc. to ISO 13850,
with yellow name plate, Ø 80 mm, with inscription1).
Can also be used with 3TK28 safety relays.
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with positive latching
function
With rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism
Red
1 NC
2)
B
3SB3303-1HA20
1
1 unit
102
1 NO + 1 NC
2)
B
3SB3301-1HA20
1
1 unit
102
DT Screw terminals
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
Rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism
1)
German inscription "NOT-HALT".
2)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
Can be used with 3TK28 safety relays.
Certificate:
Version
Rated voltage
of lamp
Color of
lens
Order No.
V
Price
per PU
Indicator lights
With integrated LED
24 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3344-6AA20
3SB3344-6AA30
3SB3344-6AA40
3SB3344-6AA50
3SB3344-6AA60
3SB3344-6AA70
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Indicator lights
With integrated LED
230 AC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3352-6AA20
3SB3352-6AA30
3SB3352-6AA40
3SB3352-6AA50
3SB3352-6AA60
3SB3352-6AA70
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Indicator lights
with BA 9s lampholder
(without lamp)
–
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3304-6AA20
3SB3304-6AA30
3SB3304-6AA40
3SB3304-6AA50
3SB3304-6AA60
3SB3304-6AA70
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Indicator light
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/43
10
Signaling devices
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm
Actuators and indicators
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Color of handle DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Pushbuttons and switches with holder1)
Pushbuttons
with flat button
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear2)
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3110-0AA11
3SB3110-0AA21
3SB3110-0AA31
3SB3110-0AA41
3SB3110-0AA51
3SB3110-0AA61
3SB3110-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with raised front ring
(height 13 mm)
Black
Red
Green
White
B
B
C
B
3SB3110-0AA12
3SB3110-0AA22
3SB3110-0AA42
3SB3110-0AA62
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with raised front ring, castellated
(height 13 mm)
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
White
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3110-0AA13
3SB3110-0AA23
3SB3110-0AA33
3SB3110-0AA43
3SB3110-0AA63
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with flat button
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Red2)
Yellow2)
Green2)
Blue2)
White
Clear2)
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3111-0AA21
3SB3111-0AA31
3SB3111-0AA41
3SB3111-0AA51
3SB3111-0AA61
3SB3111-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons, latching,
with flat button
Unlocking by pressing again
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
C
B
3SB3110-0DA11
3SB3110-0DA21
3SB3110-0DA31
3SB3110-0DA41
3SB3110-0DA51
3SB3110-0DA61
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons, latching,
with flat button
(incl. holder for 3 elements),
unlatches by pressing again,
Red2)
Yellow2)
Green2)
Blue2)
White
Clear2)
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3111-0DA21
3SB3111-0DA31
3SB3111-0DA41
3SB3111-0DA51
3SB3111-0DA61
3SB3111-0DA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbutton
Pushbutton with raised
front ring
Pushbutton with raised
front ring, castellated
10
Illuminated pushbutton
Pushbutton
Illuminated pushbutton
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
10/44
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Version
Illumination
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Black
Red
Green
White
B
B
B
B
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
Nonilluminated
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3110-2KA11
3SB3110-2KA21
3SB3110-2KA41
3SB3110-2KA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3111-2KA21
3SB3111-2KA31
3SB3111-2KA41
3SB3111-2KA51
3SB3111-2KA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Green
White
B
C
C
C
3SB3110-2LA11
3SB3110-2LA21
3SB3110-2LA41
3SB3110-2LA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
B
C
C
C
B
3SB3111-2LA21
3SB3111-2LA31
3SB3111-2LA41
3SB3111-2LA51
3SB3111-2LA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Green
White
B
B
C
C
3SB3110-2DA11
3SB3110-2DA21
3SB3110-2DA41
3SB3110-2DA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
C
B
3SB3111-2DA21
3SB3111-2DA31
3SB3111-2DA41
3SB3111-2DA51
3SB3111-2DA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Nonilluminated
Black
Red
Green
White
B
B
C
C
3SB3110-2EA11
3SB3110-2EA21
3SB3110-2EA41
3SB3110-2EA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
Red
(incl. holder for Yellow
3 elements)
Green
Blue
Clear
C
C
B
C
B
3SB3111-2EA21
3SB3111-2EA31
3SB3111-2EA41
3SB3111-2EA51
3SB3111-2EA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Selector switches with holder1)
Selector switches with 2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I,
50° operating angle,
latching
Selector switch
Switching sequence O-I,
50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
Selector switch,
illuminated
Nonilluminated
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating angle,
latching
Selector switch
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
Selector switch,
illuminated
NonSwitching sequence I-O-II,
illuminated
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type to the left,
latching to the right
Black
Green
White
B
C
B
3SB3110-2GA11
3SB3110-2GA41
3SB3110-2GA61
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Nonilluminated
Black
Red
Green
B
C
B
3SB3110-2FA11
3SB3110-2FA21
3SB3110-2FA41
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Switching sequence I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating angle,
latching to the left, momentary
contact type to the right
1)
Nonilluminated
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/45
10
Selector switches with 3 switch positions
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Lock version
Type
DT Order No.
Lock No./ Key
color
removal
position
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Key-operated switches with holder1)
Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I,
50° operating angle,
latching
RONIS key-operated switch
RONIS
SB 30
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3110-4AD11
3SB3110-4AD01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
CES
SSG 10
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3110-4LD11
3SB3110-4LD01
3SB3110-4LD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
LSG 1
O+I
O
C
B
3SB3110-4LF01
3SB3110-4LF11
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
E2 for
VW2)
O
B
3SB3110-5AE31
1
1 unit
102
E7 for
VW2)
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3110-5AE41
3SB3110-5AE51
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
E9 for
VW2)
O
B
3SB3110-5AE71
1
1 unit
102
73037
Red
O
B
3SB3110-3AH01
1
1 unit
102
73034
Black
O+I
B
3SB3110-3AJ11
1
1 unit
102
BKS
O.M.R.3)
CES key-operated switch
Switching sequence O-I,
50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
RONIS
SB 30
O
B
3SB3110-4BD01
1
1 unit
102
CES
SSG 10
O
B
3SB3110-4MD01
1
1 unit
102
Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
2 x 50° operating angle,
CES
latching
I+O+II
B
3SB3110-4DD11
1
1 unit
102
I+O+II
O
B
B
3SB3110-4PD11
3SB3110-4PD01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
SB 30
O
B
3SB3110-4ED01
1
1 unit
102
SSG 10
O
B
3SB3110-4QD01
1
1 unit
102
Switching sequence I-O-II, CES
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type to
the left,
latching to the right
SSG 10
O
B
3SB3110-4SD01
1
1 unit
102
Switching sequence I-O-II, CES
2 x 50° operating angle,
latching to the left,
momentary contact type to
the right
SSG 10
O+I
C
3SB3110-4RD51
1
1 unit
102
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
O.M.R. key-operated switch 2 x 50° operating angle,
CES
momentary contact type
10
SB 30
SSG 10
For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69.
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
Keys are not included in scope of supply.
3)
According to FIAT standards; also available for other users.
10/46
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Plastic, Square, 26 mm × 26 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Color of
handle
Approval
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU (UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850
and IEC 60947-5-5, with holder1)2).
Can also be used with 3TK28 safety relays.
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with positive latching
acc. to ISO 13850,
rotate-to-unlatch mechanism
Red
B
3SB3110-1HA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with RONIS key-operated switch
(with 2 keys), lock No. SB 30,
with positive latching
acc. to ISO 13850,
unlocking only possible using key
Red
B
3SB3110-1BA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with CES key-operated switch
(with 2 keys), lock No. SSG 10,
with positive latching
acc. to ISO 13850,
unlocking only possible using key
Red
B
3SB3110-1KA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with BKS key-operated switch
(with 2 keys),
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton with lock No. S1, with positive latching
acc. to ISO 13850,
CES key-operated switch
unlocking only possible using key
Red
B
3SB3110-1LA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with O.M.R. key-operated switch
(with 2 keys), lock No. 73037
with positive latching
acc. to
ISO 13850,
unlocking only possible using key
Red
B
3SB3110-1MA20
1
1 unit
102
Price PU (UNIT,
per PU
SET, M)
PS*
PG
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton, rotate-tounlatch mechanism
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton with
O.M.R. key-operated switch
For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69.
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
The yellow backing plates must be ordered separately, see Accessories.
Version
Color of lens
DT Order No.
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
White
B
B
B
B
B
B
Signaling elements with holder1)
Indicator lights
3SB3111-6AA20
3SB3111-6AA30
3SB3111-6AA40
3SB3111-6AA50
3SB3111-6AA70
3SB3111-6AA60
Indicator light
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and quote
order code "B01".
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/47
10
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton with
RONIS key-operated switch
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
■ Selection and ordering data
The following applies to all complete units:
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Rated voltage of lamp Color of
handle
Contacts for
front plate
mounting
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
V
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Pushbuttons
Pushbuttons with flat button
--
Pushbutton with
flat button
Black
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
1 NO
1 NC
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
}
B
}
B
}
B
}
3SB3602-0AA11
3SB3603-0AA11
3SB3603-0AA21
3SB3602-0AA31
3SB3602-0AA41
3SB3602-0AA51
3SB3602-0AA61
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3602-0AA11-0CC0
3SB3603-0AA11-0CC0
3SB3603-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3602-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3602-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3602-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3602-0AA61-0CC0
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3601-0AA11
3SB3601-0AA21
3SB3601-0AA31
3SB3601-0AA41
3SB3601-0AA51
3SB3601-0AA61
3SB3601-0AA71
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3601-0AA11-0CC0
3SB3601-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3601-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3601-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3601-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3601-0AA61-0CC0
--
Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button
With integrated LED (incl. holder for 3 elements)
24 AC/DC
Illuminated pushbutton
with flat button
10
110 AC
230 AC
1)
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3646-0AA21
3SB3645-0AA31
3SB3645-0AA41
3SB3645-0AA51
3SB3645-0AA61
3SB3645-0AA71
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3646-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3645-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3645-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3645-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3645-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3645-0AA71-0CC0
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3647-0AA21
3SB3647-0AA31
3SB3647-0AA41
3SB3647-0AA51
3SB3647-0AA61
3SB3647-0AA71
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3647-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3647-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3647-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3647-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3647-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3647-0AA71-0CC0
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
B
B
B
B
B
D
3SB3650-0AA21
3SB3657-0AA31
3SB3657-0AA41
3SB3657-0AA51
3SB3657-0AA61
3SB3657-0AA71
-------
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
D
B
B
3SB3651-0AA21
3SB3651-0AA31
3SB3651-0AA41
3SB3651-0AA51
3SB3651-0AA61
3SB3651-0AA71
-------
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
}
B
}
D
B
}
3SB3654-0AA21
3SB3653-0AA31
3SB3653-0AA41
3SB3653-0AA51
3SB3653-0AA61
3SB3653-0AA71
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3654-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3653-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3653-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3653-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3653-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3653-0AA71-0CC0
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
D
B
B
3SB3655-0AA21
3SB3655-0AA31
3SB3655-0AA41
3SB3655-0AA51
3SB3655-0AA61
3SB3655-0AA71
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3655-0AA21-0CC0
3SB3655-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3655-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3655-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3655-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3655-0AA71-0CC0
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
10/48
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Rated voltage of lamp Color of
handle
Contacts for
front plate
mounting
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
V
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Pushbuttons
Illuminated pushbuttons with flat button
With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
--
Illuminated pushbutton
with flat button
Red1)
Amber1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
B
D
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3607-0AA21
3SB3606-0AA01
3SB3606-0AA31
3SB3606-0AA41
3SB3606-0AA51
3SB3606-0AA61
3SB3606-0AA71
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3607-0AA21-0CC0
-3SB3606-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3606-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3606-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3606-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3606-0AA71-0CC0
Red1)
Amber1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3605-0AA21
3SB3605-0AA01
3SB3605-0AA31
3SB3605-0AA41
3SB3605-0AA51
3SB3605-0AA61
3SB3605-0AA71
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3605-0AA21-0CC0
-3SB3605-0AA31-0CC0
3SB3605-0AA41-0CC0
3SB3605-0AA51-0CC0
3SB3605-0AA61-0CC0
3SB3605-0AA71-0CC0
Illuminated pushbuttons with flat,
solvent-resistant button2),
With integrated LED (incl. holder for 3 elements)
24 AC/DC
Illuminated pushbutton
with flat button
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NC
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
1 NO
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3646-0AA21-0PA0
3SB3645-0AA31-0PA0
3SB3645-0AA41-0PA0
3SB3645-0AA51-0PA0
3SB3645-0AA61-0PA0
3SB3645-0AA71-0PA0
-------
Red1)
Yellow1)
Green1)
Blue1)
White
Clear1)
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3647-0AA21-0PA0
3SB3647-0AA31-0PA0
3SB3647-0AA41-0PA0
3SB3647-0AA51-0PA0
3SB3647-0AA61-0PA0
3SB3647-0AA71-0PA0
-------
1 NC
B
3SB3603-1CA21
C
3SB3603-1CA21-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC
B
3SB3601-1CA21
C
3SB3601-1CA21-0CC0
Mushroom pushbuttons
--
Red
10
Mushroom push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching
With pull-to-unlatch mechanism
Mushroom push-pull
button
1)
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
2)
Not suitable for laser inscription.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/49
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Version
Color of
handle/
Lock No.
Contacts for
front plate
mounting
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Selector switches
Selector switches, 2 switch positions
Switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle
Latching
Selector switch
Black
1 NO
}
3SB3602-2KA11
C
3SB3602-2KA11-0CC0
Standard
1 NO + 1 NC
B
3SB3601-2KA11
C
3SB3601-2KA11-0CC0
Heavy duty
1 NO
D
3SB3602-2PA11
--
1 NO + 1 NC
D
3SB3601-2PA11
--
Selector switches, 3 switch positions
Switching sequence I-O-II, 2 x 50° operating angle
Latching
Black
Heavy duty
Momentary contact
type
Black
Heavy duty
}
3SB3610-2DA11
C
3SB3610-2DA11-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC, }
1 NO + 1 NC
3SB3608-2DA11
C
3SB3608-2DA11-0CC0
1 NO, 1 NO
1 NO, 1 NO
D
3SB3610-2SA11
--
1 NO + 1 NC, D
1 NO + 1 NC
3SB3608-2SA11
--
}
3SB3610-2EA11
C
3SB3610-2EA11-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC, B
1 NO + 1 NC
3SB3608-2EA11
C
3SB3608-2EA11-0CC0
1 NO, 1 NO
D
3SB3610-2TA11
--
1 NO + 1 NC, D
1 NO + 1 NC
3SB3608-2TA11
--
1 NO, 1 NO
Key-operated switches
RONIS key-operated switches,
2 switch positions
With 2 keys, removal position O + I,
switching sequence O-I, 50° operating angle
Latching
SB 30
1 NO
}
3SB3602-4AD11
C
3SB3602-4AD11-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC
B
3SB3601-4AD11
C
3SB3601-4AD11-0CC0
10
RONIS key-operated
switch
10/50
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Color of handle
DT Screw terminals
Contacts for
front plate
mounting
Order No.
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850,
with yellow name plate, Ø 80 mm, with inscription
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons,
Ø 40 mm, with positive latching function
With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism
• German inscription
"NOT-HALT"
Red
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
with rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism
1 NC
1)
}
3SB3603-1HA20
B
3SB3603-1HA20-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3601-1HA20
B
3SB3601-1HA20-0CC0
1 NC + 1 NC
1)
-
B
3SB3611-1HA20-0CC0
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3603-1HR20
--
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3601-1HR20
--
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3603-1HP20
--
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3601-1HP20
--
1 NC
1)
}
3SB3603-1HA26
B
3SB3603-1HA26-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3601-1HA26
B
3SB3601-1HA26-0CC0
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3603-1HR26
--
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3601-1HR26
--
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3603-1TA20
B
3SB3603-1TA20-0CC0
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3601-1TA20
B
3SB3601-1TA20-0CC0
1 NC + 1 NC
1)
--
B
3SB3611-1TA20-0CC0
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3603-1TR20
--
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3601-1TR20
--
1 NC
1)
B
3SB3603-1TP20
--
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SB3601-1TP20
--
• English inscription
"EMERGENCY STOP"
Red
• French inscription
"ARRET D’URGENCE"
Red
With rotate-to-unlatch mechanism and
mechanical switch position indication
• German inscription
"NOT-HALT"
Red
• English inscription
"EMERGENCY STOP"
Red
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
with rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism and switch
position indication
10
With pull-to-unlatch mechanism,
solvent-resistant2)
• German inscription
"NOT-HALT"
Red
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
with pull-to-unlatch
mechanism
• English inscription
"EMERGENCY STOP"
Red
• French inscription
"ARRET D’URGENCE"
Red
1)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
Can be used with 3TK28 safety relays.
Certificate:
2)
Not suitable for laser inscription.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/51
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Complete units
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 1 UNIT
PG
= 102
Rated voltage
of lamp
Color of lens DT Screw terminals
Order No.
V
DT Spring-type terminals
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Indicator lights
Indicator lights with lens
with concentric rings1)
With integrated LED
24 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3644-6BA20
3SB3644-6BA30
3SB3644-6BA40
3SB3644-6BA50
3SB3644-6BA60
3SB3644-6BA70
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3644-6BA20-0CC0
3SB3644-6BA30-0CC0
3SB3644-6BA40-0CC0
3SB3644-6BA50-0CC0
3SB3644-6BA60-0CC0
3SB3644-6BA70-0CC0
110 AC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3648-6BA20
3SB3648-6BA30
3SB3648-6BA40
3SB3648-6BA50
3SB3648-6BA60
3SB3648-6BA70
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3648-6BA20-0CC0
3SB3648-6BA30-0CC0
3SB3648-6BA40-0CC0
3SB3648-6BA50-0CC0
3SB3648-6BA60-0CC0
3SB3648-6BA70-0CC0
230 AC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3652-6BA20
3SB3652-6BA30
3SB3652-6BA40
3SB3652-6BA50
3SB3652-6BA60
3SB3652-6BA70
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3652-6BA20-0CC0
3SB3652-6BA30-0CC0
3SB3652-6BA40-0CC0
3SB3652-6BA50-0CC0
3SB3652-6BA60-0CC0
3SB3652-6BA70-0CC0
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3604-6BA20
3SB3604-6BA30
3SB3604-6BA40
3SB3604-6BA50
3SB3604-6BA60
3SB3604-6BA70
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3604-6BA20-0CC0
3SB3604-6BA30-0CC0
3SB3604-6BA40-0CC0
3SB3604-6BA50-0CC0
3SB3604-6BA60-0CC0
3SB3604-6BA70-0CC0
Indicator light
With BA 9s lampholder, without lamp
--
Inscription by inserting a label is not possible.
10
1)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
10/52
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Inscriptions
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Gray
Clear2)
}
}
B
}
B
}
B
B
Green
Red
White
Black
Blue
Pushbuttons
with flat solvent-resistant
button3)
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3500-0AA11
3SB3500-0AA21
3SB3500-0AA31
3SB3500-0AA41
3SB3500-0AA51
3SB3500-0AA61
3SB3500-0AB51
3SB3500-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
B
D
3SB3500-0AA81
3SB3500-0AB01
3SB3500-0AB11
3SB3500-0AB21
3SB3500-0AC81
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
}
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3500-0AA11
3SB3500-0AA21-0PA0
3SB3500-0AA31-0PA0
3SB3500-0AA41-0PA0
3SB3500-0AA51-0PA0
3SB3500-0AA61-0PA0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with raised button
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3500-0BA11
3SB3500-0BA21
3SB3500-0BA31
3SB3500-0BA41
3SB3500-0BA51
3SB3500-0BA61
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with raised front ring
(height 15.5 mm)
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3500-0AA12
3SB3500-0AA22
3SB3500-0AA32
3SB3500-0AA42
3SB3500-0AA52
3SB3500-0AA62
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with flat button
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Amber2)
Red2)
Yellow2)
Green2)
Blue2)
White
Clear2)
C
}
B
}
B
B
}
3SB3501-0AA01
3SB3501-0AA21
3SB3501-0AA31
3SB3501-0AA41
3SB3501-0AA51
3SB3501-0AA61
3SB3501-0AA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with flat, solvent-resistant
button3)
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Red2)
Yellow2)
Green2)
Blue2)
White
Clear2)
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3501-0AA21-0PA0
3SB3501-0AA31-0PA0
3SB3501-0AA41-0PA0
3SB3501-0AA51-0PA0
3SB3501-0AA61-0PA0
3SB3501-0AA71-0PA0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with raised button
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-0BA01
3SB3501-0BA21
3SB3501-0BA31
3SB3501-0BA41
3SB3501-0BA51
3SB3501-0BA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with flat button,
latching
Unlatches by pressing again
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Gray
B
B
B
B
B
B
D
3SB3500-0DA11
3SB3500-0DA21
3SB3500-0DA31
3SB3500-0DA41
3SB3500-0DA51
3SB3500-0DA61
3SB3500-0DB51
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated pushbuttons
with flat button,
latching,
Unlatches by pressing again,
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Amber2)
Red2)
Yellow2)
Green2)
Blue2)
White
Clear2)
D
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-0DA01
3SB3501-0DA21
3SB3501-0DA31
3SB3501-0DA41
3SB3501-0DA51
3SB3501-0DA61
3SB3501-0DA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Pushbuttons
with flat button
Pushbutton with flat button
I
O
I
O
R
Pushbutton with raised
button
Pushbutton with raised
front ring
Illuminated pushbutton
with flat button
Illuminated pushbutton
with raised button
Pushbutton
with flat button
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
Inscription is possible by inserting a label.
3)
Not suitable for laser inscription.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/53
10
Pushbuttons with holder1)
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 30 mm
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
B
B
B
B
Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3500-1DA11
3SB3500-1DA21
3SB3500-1DA31
3SB3500-1DA41
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
B
3SB3500-1GA11
3SB3500-1GA21
3SB3500-1GA31
3SB3500-1GA41
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
B
B
B
B
3SB3500-1QA11
3SB3500-1QA21
3SB3500-1QA31
3SB3500-1QA41
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 30 mm Amber
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Yellow
Green
White
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-1DA01
3SB3501-1DA31
3SB3501-1DA41
3SB3501-1DA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm Amber
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Yellow
Green
White
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-1GA01
3SB3501-1GA31
3SB3501-1GA41
3SB3501-1GA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm Amber
(incl. holder for 3 elements)
Yellow
Green
White
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-1QA01
3SB3501-1QA31
3SB3501-1QA41
3SB3501-1QA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 30 mm, latching,
pull to unlatch
Black
Red
B
B
3SB3500-1EA11
3SB3500-1EA21
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching,
pull to unlatch
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
B
B
B
C
3SB3500-1CA11
3SB3500-1CA21
3SB3500-1CA31
3SB3500-1CA41
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 60 mm, latching,
pull to unlatch
Black
Red
B
B
3SB3500-1RA11
3SB3500-1RA21
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 30 mm, latching,
pull to unlatch,
can be illuminated (incl. holder for 3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
C
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-1EA01
3SB3501-1EA21
3SB3501-1EA31
3SB3501-1EA41
3SB3501-1EA51
3SB3501-1EA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 40 mm, latching,
pull to unlatch,
can be illuminated (incl. holder for 3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
C
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-1CA01
3SB3501-1CA21
3SB3501-1CA31
3SB3501-1CA41
3SB3501-1CA51
3SB3501-1CA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Push-pull buttons, Ø 60 mm, latching,
pull to unlatch,
can be illuminated (incl. holder for 3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
C
B
B
C
B
D
3SB3501-1RA01
3SB3501-1RA21
3SB3501-1RA31
3SB3501-1RA41
3SB3501-1RA51
3SB3501-1RA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Mushroom pushbuttons with holder1)
Mushroom pushbutton,
Ø 30 mm
Mushroom pushbutton,
Ø 40 mm
10
Illuminated mushroom
pushbutton,
Ø 60 mm
Push-pull button,
Ø 30 mm
Push-pull button,
Ø 40 mm
Push-pull button,
Ø 60 mm, can be illuminated
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
10/54
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Version
Illumination
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Black
Red
Green
White
}
A
C
B
Non-illuminated,
with solvent-resistant
knob1)
Black
Red
Green
Illuminated,
standard version1)
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Switching
Non-illuminated,
sequence O-I,
standard version1)
50° operating angle,
latching
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3500-2HA11
3SB3500-2HA21
3SB3500-2HA41
3SB3500-2HA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
3SB3500-2HA11-0PA0
3SB3500-2HA21-0PA0
3SB3500-2HA41-0PA0
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3501-2HA01
3SB3501-2HA21
3SB3501-2HA31
3SB3501-2HA41
3SB3501-2HA51
3SB3501-2HA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB3500-2KA11
3SB3500-2KA21
3SB3500-2KA41
3SB3500-2KA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
with solvent-resistant
knob1)
Black
Red
Green
D
D
B
3SB3500-2KA11-0PA0
3SB3500-2KA21-0PA0
3SB3500-2KA41-0PA0
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Illuminated,
standard version1)
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-2KA01
3SB3501-2KA21
3SB3501-2KA31
3SB3501-2KA41
3SB3501-2KA51
3SB3501-2KA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
with solvent-resistant
knob1) (incl. holder for
3 elements)
Red
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-2KA21-0PA0
3SB3501-2KA41-0PA0
3SB3501-2KA51-0PA0
3SB3501-2KA71-0PA0
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
heavy-duty version
Black
Red
Green
White
C
D
D
D
3SB3500-2PA11
3SB3500-2PA21
3SB3500-2PA41
3SB3500-2PA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
heavy-duty version
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-2PA01
3SB3501-2PA21
3SB3501-2PA31
3SB3501-2PA41
3SB3501-2PA51
3SB3501-2PA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
long handle
Black
Red
Green
White
D
D
D
D
3SB3500-3PA11
3SB3500-3PA21
3SB3500-3PA41
3SB3500-3PA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
long handle
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-3PA21
3SB3501-3PA31
3SB3501-3PA41
3SB3501-3PA51
3SB3501-3PA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Selector switches with holders
Switching
Non-illuminated,
sequence O-I,
standard version1)
90° operating angle,
latching
Selector switch,
2 switch positions,
standard version, 90°
Selector switch,
2 switch positions,
standard version, 50°
Selector switch,
2 switch positions,
heavy-duty version
Selector switch,
2 switch positions,
long handle
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/55
10
Selector switches with 2 switch positions
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Version
Illumination
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
Black
Red
Green
Illuminated,
standard version1)
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3500-2LA11
3SB3500-2LA21
3SB3500-2LA41
3SB3500-2LA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
3SB3500-2LA11-0PA0
3SB3500-2LA21-0PA0
3SB3500-2LA41-0PA0
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-2LA01
3SB3501-2LA21
3SB3501-2LA31
3SB3501-2LA41
3SB3501-2LA51
3SB3501-2LA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
with solvent-resistant
knob1) (incl. holder for
3 elements)
Red
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
B
3SB3501-2LA21-0PA0
3SB3501-2LA41-0PA0
3SB3501-2LA51-0PA0
3SB3501-2LA71-0PA0
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
heavy-duty version
Black
Red
Green
White
D
D
D
D
3SB3500-2QA11
3SB3500-2QA21
3SB3500-2QA41
3SB3500-2QA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
heavy-duty
version
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-2QA01
3SB3501-2QA21
3SB3501-2QA31
3SB3501-2QA41
3SB3501-2QA51
3SB3501-2QA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
long handle
Black
Red
Green
D
D
D
3SB3500-3QA11
3SB3500-3QA21
3SB3500-3QA41
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Illuminated
long handle
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-3QA21
3SB3501-3QA31
3SB3501-3QA41
3SB3501-3QA51
3SB3501-3QA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Selector switches with holders
Selector switches with 2 switch positions
Switching
Non-illuminated,
sequence O-I,
standard version1)
50° operating angle,
momentary contact
type
Non-illuminated,
with solvent-resistant
knob1)
Selector switch,
2 switch positions,
standard version
Selector switch,
2 switch positions,
heavy-duty version
Selector switch,
2 switch positions,
long handle
10
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
10/56
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Version
Illumination
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Non-illuminated,
standard version1)
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
Non-illuminated,
with solvent-resistant
knob1)
Black
Red
Green
Illuminated,
standard version 1)
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3500-2DA11
3SB3500-2DA21
3SB3500-2DA41
3SB3500-2DA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
3SB3500-2DA11-0PA0
3SB3500-2DA21-0PA0
3SB3500-2DA41-0PA0
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-2DA01
3SB3501-2DA21
3SB3501-2DA31
3SB3501-2DA41
3SB3501-2DA51
3SB3501-2DA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
with solvent-resistant
knob1)
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Red
Green
Blue
Clear
B
D
B
D
3SB3501-2DA21-0PA0
3SB3501-2DA41-0PA0
3SB3501-2DA51-0PA0
3SB3501-2DA71-0PA0
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
heavy-duty version
Black
Red
Green
White
C
D
D
D
3SB3500-2SA11
3SB3500-2SA21
3SB3500-2SA41
3SB3500-2SA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
heavy-duty version
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-2SA01
3SB3501-2SA21
3SB3501-2SA31
3SB3501-2SA41
3SB3501-2SA51
3SB3501-2SA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
long handle
Black
Red
Green
White
D
D
D
D
3SB3500-3SA11
3SB3500-3SA21
3SB3500-3SA41
3SB3500-3SA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
long handle
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-3SA21
3SB3501-3SA31
3SB3501-3SA41
3SB3501-3SA51
3SB3501-3SA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
standard version1)
Black
Red
Green
White
}
B
B
B
3SB3500-2EA11
3SB3500-2EA21
3SB3500-2EA41
3SB3500-2EA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
with solvent-resistant
knob1)
Black
Red
Green
B
B
B
3SB3500-2EA11-0PA0
3SB3500-2EA21-0PA0
3SB3500-2EA41-0PA0
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Illuminated,
standard version1)
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3501-2EA01
3SB3501-2EA21
3SB3501-2EA31
3SB3501-2EA41
3SB3501-2EA51
3SB3501-2EA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
with solvent-resistant
knob1)
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Red
Green
Blue
Clear
B
B
B
D
3SB3501-2EA21-0PA0
3SB3501-2EA41-0PA0
3SB3501-2EA51-0PA0
3SB3501-2EA71-0PA0
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Selector switches with holders
Switching
sequence
I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating
angle,
latching
Selector switch,
3 switch positions,
standard version
Selector switch,
3 switch positions,
heavy-duty version
Selector switch,
3 switch positions,
long handle
Switching
sequence
I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating
angle,
momentary contact
type
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/57
10
Selector switches with 3 switch positions
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Version
Illumination
Color of
handle
DT Order No.
Non-illuminated,
heavy-duty
version
Black
Red
Green
White
C
D
D
D
Illuminated,
heavy-duty version
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
Non-illuminated,
long handle
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3500-2TA11
3SB3500-2TA21
3SB3500-2TA41
3SB3500-2TA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
D
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-2TA01
3SB3501-2TA21
3SB3501-2TA31
3SB3501-2TA41
3SB3501-2TA51
3SB3501-2TA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Red
Green
White
D
D
D
D
3SB3500-3TA11
3SB3500-3TA21
3SB3500-3TA41
3SB3500-3TA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated
long handle
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-3TA21
3SB3501-3TA31
3SB3501-3TA41
3SB3501-3TA51
3SB3501-3TA71
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
standard version1)
Black
Red
Green
White
B
B
B
B
3SB3500-2GA11
3SB3500-2GA21
3SB3500-2GA41
3SB3500-2GA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
standard version1)
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
B
D
D
3SB3501-2GA01
3SB3501-2GA21
3SB3501-2GA31
3SB3501-2GA41
3SB3501-2GA51
3SB3501-2GA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
heavy-duty version
Black
Red
Green
White
D
D
D
D
3SB3500-2VA11
3SB3500-2VA21
3SB3500-2VA41
3SB3500-2VA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
heavy-duty version
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-2VA01
3SB3501-2VA21
3SB3501-2VA31
3SB3501-2VA41
3SB3501-2VA51
3SB3501-2VA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
long handle
Black
Red
D
D
3SB3500-3VA11
3SB3500-3VA21
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
Non-illuminated,
standard version1)
Black
Red
Green
White
B
D
B
B
3SB3500-2FA11
3SB3500-2FA21
3SB3500-2FA41
3SB3500-2FA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
standard version1)
(incl. holder for
3 elements)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
B
D
B
3SB3501-2FA01
3SB3501-2FA21
3SB3501-2FA31
3SB3501-2FA41
3SB3501-2FA51
3SB3501-2FA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
heavy-duty version
Black
Red
Green
White
D
D
D
D
3SB3500-2UA11
3SB3500-2UA21
3SB3500-2UA41
3SB3500-2UA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Illuminated,
heavy-duty version
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
Clear
D
D
D
D
D
D
3SB3501-2UA01
3SB3501-2UA21
3SB3501-2UA31
3SB3501-2UA41
3SB3501-2UA51
3SB3501-2UA71
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Non-illuminated,
long handle
Black
Red
Green
White
D
D
D
D
3SB3500-3UA11
3SB3500-3UA21
3SB3500-3UA41
3SB3500-3UA61
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
Selector switches with holders
Selector switches with 3 switch positions
Switching
sequence
I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
Selector switch,
3 switch positions,
standard version
Selector switch,
3 switch positions,
heavy-duty version
Switching
sequence
I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type
to the left,
latching to the right
10
Selector switch,
3 switch positions,
long handle
Switching
sequence
I-O-II,
2 x 50° operating angle,
latching to the left,
momentary contact type
to the right
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
10/58
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Lock version
Type
DT Order No.
Lock No./ Key
color
removal
position
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Key-operated switches with holder1)
SB 30
O+I
O
I
}
}
B
3SB3500-4AD11
3SB3500-4AD01
3SB3500-4AD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
SSG 10
O+I
O
I
}
}
B
3SB3500-4LD11
3SB3500-4LD01
3SB3500-4LD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
LSG 1
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3500-4LF01
3SB3500-4LF11
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
S1
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3500-5AD11
3SB3500-5AD01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
E1 for
VW2)
O
B
3SB3500-5AE11
1
1 unit
102
E2 for
VW2)
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3500-5AE21
3SB3500-5AE31
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
E7 for
VW2)
O+I
O
B
B
3SB3500-5AE41
3SB3500-5AE51
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
E9 for
VW2)
O
B
3SB3500-5AE71
1
1 unit
102
73038
O+I
Light blue O
I
B
B
B
3SB3500-3AG11
3SB3500-3AG01
3SB3500-3AG21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
73037
Red
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3500-3AH11
3SB3500-3AH01
3SB3500-3AH21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
73034
Black
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3500-3AJ11
3SB3500-3AJ01
3SB3500-3AJ21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
73033
Yellow
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3500-3AK11
3SB3500-3AK01
3SB3500-3AK21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
SB 30
O
}
3SB3500-4BD01
1
1 unit
102
SSG 10
O
}
3SB3500-4MD01
1
1 unit
102
LSG 1
O
B
3SB3500-4MF11
1
1 unit
102
BKS
S1
O
B
3SB3500-5BD01
1
1 unit
102
O.M.R.3)
73038
O
Light blue
B
3SB3500-3BG01
1
1 unit
102
73037
Red
O
B
3SB3500-3BH01
1
1 unit
102
73034
Black
O
B
3SB3500-3BJ01
1
1 unit
102
73033
Yellow
O
B
3SB3500-3BK01
1
1 unit
102
Switching sequence O-I, RONIS
50° operating angle,
latching
CES
RONIS key-operated switch
BKS
CES key-operated switch
O.M.R.3)
BKS key-operated switch
Switching sequence O-I, RONIS
50° operating angle,
CES
momentary contact type
O.M.R. key-operated switch
For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69.
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
Keys are not included in scope of supply.
3)
According to FIAT standards; also available for other users.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/59
10
Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 2 switch positions
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Lock version
Type
DT Order No.
Lock No./ Key
color
removal
position
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Key-operated switches with holder1)
Key-operated switches with 2 keys, 3 switch positions
SB 30
I+O+II
O
I+II
I
II
O+I
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3500-4DD11
3SB3500-4DD01
3SB3500-4DD41
3SB3500-4DD21
3SB3500-4DD31
3SB3500-4DD51
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
CES
SSG 10
O+I+II
O
I+II
I
II
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3500-4PD11
3SB3500-4PD01
3SB3500-4PD41
3SB3500-4PD21
3SB3500-4PD31
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
BKS
S1
O
I+II
C
C
3SB3500-5DD01
3SB3500-5DD41
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
O.M.R.2)
73038
I+O+II
Light blue
B
3SB3500-3DG11
1
1 unit
102
73037
Red
I+O+II
B
3SB3500-3DH11
1
1 unit
102
73034
Black
I+O+II
O
B
B
3SB3500-3DJ11
3SB3500-3DJ01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
2 x 50° operating angle,
CES
momentary contact type
BKS
SB 30
O
B
3SB3500-4ED01
1
1 unit
102
SSG 10
O
B
3SB3500-4QD01
1
1 unit
102
S1
O
B
3SB3500-5ED01
1
1 unit
102
O.M.R.
73034
Black
O
B
3SB3500-3EJ01
1
1 unit
102
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
2 x 50° operating angle,
momentary contact type to CES
the left,
latching to the right
SB 30
O + II
O
B
B
3SB3500-4GD61
3SB3500-4GD01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
SSG 10
O + II
O
II
B
B
B
3SB3500-4SD61
3SB3500-4SD01
3SB3500-4SD31
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
BKS
S1
O + II
O
C
C
3SB3500-5GD61
3SB3500-5GD01
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
O.M.R.
73033
Yellow
II
C
3SB3500-3GK31
1
1 unit
102
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
2 x 50° operating angle,
CES
latching to the left,
momentary contact type to
the right
BKS
SB 30
O+I
B
3SB3500-4FD51
1
1 unit
102
SSG 10
O+I
O
I
B
B
B
3SB3500-4RD51
3SB3500-4RD01
3SB3500-4RD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
S1
O+I
O
I
C
B
B
3SB3500-5FD51
3SB3500-5FD01
3SB3500-5FD21
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
Switching sequence I-O-II, RONIS
2 x 50° operating angle,
latching
RONIS key-operated switch
CES key-operated switch
10
BKS key-operated switch
O.M.R. key-operated switch
For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69.
1)
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
According to FIAT standards; also available for other users.
10/60
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Color of
handle
Approval DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
EMERGENCY-STOP devices according to ISO 13850 and
IEC 60947-5-5 with holder1)2).
Can also be used with 3TK28 safety relays.
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 32 mm
With positive latching
acc. to ISO 13850,
with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism
• Standard version
B
3SB3500-1FA20
1
1 unit
102
• Solvent-resistant3)
B
3SB3500-1FA20-0PA0
1
1 unit
102
• Without switch position indicator
}
3SB3500-1HA20
1
1 unit
102
• Without switch position indicator,
solvent-resistant3)
B
3SB3500-1HA20-0PA0
1
1 unit
102
A
3SB3500-1HA26
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3500-1TA20
1
1 unit
102
Mushroom diameter 32 mm
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm
With positive latching
acc. to ISO 13850,
with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism
Red
Mushroom diameter 40 mm, • With mechanical switch position
indication
with rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism with switch
position indication
With pull-to-unlatch mechanism
Mushroom diameter 40 mm,
pull-to-unlatch mechanism
Red
B
3SB3500-1AA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with RONIS
key-operated switch, (with 2 keys),
lock No. SB 30, with positive latching
according to ISO 13850,
unlocking only possible using key
Red
B
3SB3500-1BA20
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
Red
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with CES
key-operated switch, (with 2 keys),
Mushroom diameter 40 mm, lock No. SSG 10, with positive latching
with RONIS key-operated
according to ISO 13850,
switch
unlocking only possible using key
B
3SB3500-1KA20
1
1 unit
102
Red
B
3SB3500-1LA20
1
1 unit
102
Red
B
3SB3500-1MA20
1
1 unit
102
10
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm
With positive latching
acc. to ISO 13850,
with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism
Mushroom diameter 60 mm
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with BKS
key-operated switch, (with 2 keys),
lock No. S1, with positive latching
according to ISO 13850, unlocking
only possible using key
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, with O.M.R.
key-operated switch
(with 2 keys), lock No. 73037,
Mushroom diameter 40 mm, with positive latching according to
ISO 13850, unlocking only possible
with CES key-operated
using key
switch
For BKS and CES special locks, see page 10/69.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
1) Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
The yellow backing plates must be ordered separately, see Accessories.
3)
Not suitable for laser inscription.
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/61
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Actuators and Indicators, Metal, Round, 22 mm
Actuators and indicators
Version
Color of
lens
DT Order No.
Indicator lights
with lens with concentric rings2)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
}
B
}
B
B
}
Indicator lights
with smooth lens2)
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
Indicator lights
with smooth solvent-resistant lens2)3)
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3501-6BA00
3SB3501-6BA20
3SB3501-6BA30
3SB3501-6BA40
3SB3501-6BA50
3SB3501-6BA60
3SB3501-6BA70
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
B
B
}
B
3SB3501-6AA00
3SB3501-6AA20
3SB3501-6AA30
3SB3501-6AA40
3SB3501-6AA50
3SB3501-6AA60
3SB3501-6AA70
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3501-6AA20-0PA0
3SB3501-6AA30-0PA0
3SB3501-6AA40-0PA0
3SB3501-6AA50-0PA0
3SB3501-6AA60-0PA0
3SB3501-6AA70-0PA0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
102
Signaling elements with holder1)
Indicator light
with smooth lens
Also available without holder. Supplement Order No. with "–Z" and quote
order code "B01".
2)
Inscription by inserting a label is not possible.
3)
Not suitable for laser inscription.
10
1)
10/62
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Components for Actuators and Indicators
Contact blocks and lampholders
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Diagram
DT Screw terminals
Operating travel
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3400-0B
1
1 unit
102
3SB3400-0BA
1
1 unit
102
3SB3400-0C
1
1 unit
102
3SB3400-0CA
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3400-0M
1
1 unit
102
}
3SB3400-0A
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3400-0AA
1
1 unit
102
D
3SB3400-0N
1
1 unit
102
Contact closed
Order No.
Contact open
Price
per PU
Contact blocks for front plate mounting
Contact blocks with one contact
• Mounting depth: 50 mm
3
NSD0_00015
NSD00006
1 NO
1 NO with gold-plated
contacts
3-4
0 1
mm
4
1 NC
1)
1 NC with gold-plated
contacts
1)
1
2
1-2
0 1
mm
• With mounting monitoring
contact2), mounting
depth 63 mm
4
2,3
2
3
4
1,6
NSD0_00017
1-2
0 1
mm
1)
1 NC
3
NSD0_00017
NSD00007
3SB34 00-0B
2
3SB34 00-0M
2
3
4
1,6
Contact blocks with 2 contacts
Mounting depth 63 mm (including unit labeling plate)
1)
1 NO + 1 NC with dust
protection3)
1)
31
1 NO leading + 1 NC lagging
3SB34 00-0A
75
1 NO leading + 1 NC lagging
with gold-plated contacts
86
2 NO
3 3
NSD00034
42
2 NO with gold-plated contacts
2 NO with dust protection3)
4 4
NSD00038
3-4
1-2
0 1 2 3
mm
1,6 2,3
4
NSD00037b
7-8
5-6
0 1 2 3
mm
1,3 2,2
NSD00039
2
3
3SB3400-0H
1
1 unit
102
3SB3400-0HA
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3400-0D
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3400-0DA
1
1 unit
102
C
3SB3400-0P
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3400-0E
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3400-0EA
1
1 unit
102
C
3SB3400-0Q
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3400-2A
1
1 unit
102
4
3-4
3-4
0 1
mm
B
D
4
1)
2 NC with gold-plated
contacts
1)
3)
2 NC with dust protection
1 1
2 2
1)
NSD00036
2,3
2 NC
NSD00040
1-2
1-2
0 1
mm
2
3
4
1,6
Blocks with 2 diodes type 1N 4007
Mounting depth: 63 mm
URMS = max. 250 V
IFAV = 0.8 A
at Tu = 60 °C
(L+)
X5
X7
(L-)
X6
X8
NSD00113
3SB34 00-2A
1)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
2)
The NC contact opens automatically upon disconnection of the actuator.
On delivery, the contact is open (= safe state).
Activation (= NC contacts on the non-actuated control device are closed)
takes place upon first-time actuation after the contact block is snapped
onto the actuator.
Unsuitable for mounting in 3SB38 enclosures.
3)
With 3SB30 01-0CH dust protection shield
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/63
10
1 NO + 1 NC with goldplated contacts
NSD00033
1)
NSD00035
1 NO + 1 NC
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Components for Actuators and Indicators
Contact blocks and lampholders
Version
Diagram
Rated voltage
of lamp
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
V
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Contact blocks for front plate mounting
BA 9s lampholders, mounting depth 50 mm
Without lamp
With 24 V incandescent lamp
(3SX1 344)
X1
(L+)
X2
(L-)
Acc. to lamp
}
3SB3400-1A
1
1 unit
102
24 AC/DC
B
3SB3400-1D
1
1 unit
102
110/130
AC/DC
B
3SB3400-1B
1
1 unit
102
230/240 AC
B
3SB3400-1C
1
1 unit
102
230/240 AC
B
3SB3400-1F
1
1 unit
102
Acc. to lamp
B
3SB3400-1G
1
1 unit
102
Acc. to lamp
B
3SB3400-1L
1
1 unit
102
Acc. to lamp
B
3SB3400-1H
1
1 unit
102
24 AC/DC
B
}
}
B
}
3SB3400-1PA
3SB3400-1PB
3SB3400-1PC
3SB3400-1PD
3SB3400-1PE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
110 AC
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3400-1QA
3SB3400-1QB
3SB3400-1QC
3SB3400-1QD
3SB3400-1QE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
230 AC
B
}
}
B
}
3SB3400-1RA
3SB3400-1RB
3SB3400-1RC
3SB3400-1RD
3SB3400-1RE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
127 / 24
240 / 24
260 / 24
400 / 24
B
B
D
B
3SB3400-3A
3SB3400-3C
3SB3400-3E
3SB3400-3F
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
127 / 6
240 / 6
400 / 6
480 / 6
600 / 6
B
B
B
B
D
3SB3400-3M
3SB3400-3P
3SB3400-3S
3SB3400-3U
3SB3400-3W
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
NSD00003
BA 9s lampholders, mounting depth 50 mm
3SB34 00-1A
With built-in resistor for longer
endurance and
with 130 V lamp (3SX1 731)1)
X1
(L+)
With integrated voltage reducer
and
with 130 V lamp (3SX1 731)1)
X1
X2
(L-)
NSD00041
X2
NSD00042
BA 9s lampholders
With separate lamp test function2)3)
With integrated voltage reducer
and
with 130 V lamp (3SX1 731)1)
X5
X1
X2
NSD00043
Without lamp
For incandescent lamp,
max. 2.6 W;
for LED lamp,
24/48/230 V AC/DC4)
3SB34 00-1F
Without lamp
For incandescent lamp,
max. 2.6 W;
for LED lamp, AC or DC5)
Without lamp
For incandescent lamp,
max. 2.6 W;
for glow lamp, AC
AC/DC-LED
X5
X1
(L+)
X2
(L-)
NSD0_00044b
X5
X2
X1
(L-)
(L+)
NSD00045
X5
X1
(L+)
X2
(L-)
NSD0_00046a
10
Lampholders with integrated LED
Mounting depth: 50 mm
3SB34 00-1PA
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
X1
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
X1
X2
k
k
+
NSD0_01292b
k
k
+
X2
NSD0_01296b
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
X1
k
k
+
X2
NSD0_01296b
Transformers
For snapping onto 3SB34 00-1A
lampholder
For incandescent lamp AC,
max. 2 W
X1
X2
NSD00047
Mounting depth: 97 mm
3SB34 00-3.
1)
Use these lamps only.
4)
Not suitable for LEDs which are suitable only for AC or DC.
2)
The lampholder with separate lamp test function can not be installed in an
enclosure.
5)
Not suitable for LED for 24/48/230 V AC/DC.
For connecting to DC, X5 must be connected to L–.
3)
For circuit examples see note on Technical Information on page 3/1.
10/64
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Components for Actuators and Indicators
Contact blocks and lampholders
Version
Rated voltage
of lamp/
Diagram
V
Operating travel/color DT Spring-type
terminals
Contact closed
Order No.
Contact open
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Contact blocks for front plate mounting
Contact blocks with one contact, mounting depth 50 mm
3
NSD0_00015
NSD00006
1 NO
1 NO with
gold-plated contacts
3-4
0 1
mm
4
1)
1 NC with
gold-plated contacts
1)
1
2
1-2
0 1
mm
• With mounting monitoring contact2),
mounting depth 63 mm
1 NC
3
4
3SB3403-0B
1
1 unit
102
3SB3403-0BA
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-0C
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-0CA
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-0M
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-0A
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-0AA
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-0H
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-0HA
1
1 unit
102
2,3
NSD0_00017
NSD00007
3SB34 03-0B
1 NC
2
B
B
2
3
4
1,6
NSD0_00017
1-2
0 1
mm
1)
2
3
4
1,6
Contact blocks with 2 contacts, mounting depth 63 mm
31
3-4
1-2
7-8
5-6
42
1 NO leading +
1 NC lagging
75
1 NO leading +
1 NC lagging
with gold-plated contacts
86
2 NO
3 3
NSD00038
NSD00033
1)
NSD00034
1)
0 1 2 3
mm
1,6 2,3
2 NO with gold-plated
contacts
4 4
4
NSD00037b
0 1 2 3
mm
1,3 2,2
4
B
3SB3403-0D
1
1 unit
102
D
3SB3403-0DA
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-0E
1
1 unit
102
D
3SB3403-0EA
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-1A
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3403-1C
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3403-1PA
3SB3403-1PB
3SB3403-1PC
3SB3403-1PD
3SB3403-1PE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3403-1QA
3SB3403-1QB
3SB3403-1QC
3SB3403-1QD
3SB3403-1QE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3403-1RA
3SB3403-1RB
3SB3403-1RC
3SB3403-1RD
3SB3403-1RE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
NSD00039
NSD00035
3-4
3-4
0 1
mm
3SB34 03-0A
2
3
4
2,3
1)
2 NC with gold-plated
contacts
1)
1 1
2 2
NSD00040
NSD00036
2 NC
1-2
1-2
0 1
mm
2
3
4
10
3SB34 03-0M
1 NO + 1 NC
1 NO + 1 NC
with gold-plated
contacts
1,6
BA 9s lampholders, mounting depth 50 mm
Without lamp3)
Acc. to lamp
X1
(L+)
X2
(L-)
NSD00003
3SB34 03-1C
With integrated voltage
reducer and with 130 V lamp
(3SX1 731)3)4)
230/240 V AC
Lampholders with
integrated LED
24 V AC/DC
Mounting depth: 50 mm
X2
X1
NSD00042
X1
k
X2
k
+
NSD0_01292b
110 V AC
X1
k
3SB3403-1PA
k
+
X2
NSD0_01296b
230 V AC
X1
k
k
+
X2
NSD0_01296b
1)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
3)
Not suitable for square command devices.
2)
The NC contact opens automatically upon disconnection of the actuator.
On delivery, the contact is open (= safe state).
For more explanations see footnote on page 10/63.
Unsuitable for mounting in 3SB38 enclosures.
4)
Use these lamps only.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/65
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Components for Actuators and Indicators
Contact blocks and lampholders
Version
Diagram
DT Solder pin
connections
Operating travel
Contact closed
Order No.
Contact open
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Contact blocks for use on printed circuit boards
1 NO
3
NSD00006
Contact blocks with one contact
Mounting depth 44 mm
1 NC
1)
1
3SB34 11-0B
2
NSD00007
4
NSD0_00015
3-4
0 1
mm
X1
(L+)
3
3SB3411-0B
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3411-0C
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3411-1A
1
1 unit
102
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
4
2,3
NSD0_00017
1-2
0 1
mm
Wedge base lampholders W2 x 4.6 d
Mounting depth: 44 mm
Without lamp
2
B
2
3
4
1,6
X2
(L-)
NSD00003
3SB34 11-1A
1)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
Version
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
Holders for 3 contact blocks, for front panel mounting
}
3SB3901-0AB
100 20 units
102
Holders for selector switches, key-operated switches and twin
}
pushbuttons
With pressure plate for actuating the central contact block of 3 contact
blocks
3SB3901-0AC
100 10 units
102
3SB3901-0AW
100 10 units
102
3SB3901-0AA
100 10 units
102
Holders for pushbuttons and switches1)
For snapping on 3 blocks
(for illuminated pushbuttons and illuminated selector switches the
holder is included in the scope of supply)
10
3SB39 01-0AB
3SB39 01-0AC
Pressure plates for use on printed circuit boards
Pressure plates for selector switches and key-operated switches B
For actuating the central contact block of 3 contact blocks
3SB39 01-0AW
Accessories for printed circuit boards
Holders for printed circuit boards
For mounting the command devices on the printed circuit board
(screw is included in the scope of supply)
B
3SB39 01-0AA
1)
Holder also for mushroom pushbutton and push-pull button.
10/66
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Components for Actuators and Indicators
AS-Interface F adapters
for EMERGENCY-STOP devices
■ Overview
The AS-Interface F adapter is used to connect an EMERGENCYSTOP device according to ISO 13850 from the 3SB3 series to the
AS-Interface bus system. The F adapter is suitable for control
devices with mounting on front plates.
The F adapter has a safe AS-Interface 2E slave and is snapped
from behind onto the EMERGENCY-STOP device (actuator). In
the 2E/1A expanded version, an output is also available for actuating an indicator light with LED.
Depending on the version, screw terminals or spring-type terminals or the insulation piercing method are used for connecting to
the AS-Interface bus cable. Addressing is performed using the
AS-Interface connection or the integrated addressing socket.
Safety category 4 (SIL 3) is achieved with the adapter.
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton with F adapter for
bus connection
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
DT Screw terminals
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
AS-Interface F adapters for 3SB3 EMERGENCY-STOP actuators
For mounting on front plate
• 2I
}
3SF5402-1AA03
1
1 unit
121
• 2I/1O, with output for LED control
}
3SF5402-1AB03
1
1 unit
121
Version
DT Spring-type
terminals
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Order No.
Price
per PU
AS-Interface F adapters for 3SB3 EMERGENCY-STOP actuators
For mounting on front plate
• 2I
}
3SF5402-1AA04
1
1 unit
121
• 2I/1O, with output for LED control
}
3SF5402-1AB04
1
1 unit
121
Version
DT Insulation
piercing method
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SF5 402-1AA04
Order No.
Price
per PU
AS-Interface F adapters for 3SB3 EMERGENCY-STOP actuators
For mounting on front plate
• 2I
X
3SF5402-1AA05
1
1 unit
121
• 2I/1O, with output for LED control
X
3SF5402-1AB05
1
1 unit
121
3SF5 402-1AA05
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/67
10
3SF5 402-1AA03
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Components for Actuators and Indicators
Special locks
■ Options
Special locks for key-operated switches
Master and master-pass key systems
The BKS and CES plastic and metal key-operated switches,
round and square versions, can be optionally equipped with
special locks.
The following key systems can be supplied with BKS and CES
key-operated switches:
• Central lock systems
• Master key systems
• Central master key systems
• Master-pass key systems
In this case the Order No. of the matching key-operated switch
must be supplemented with "-Z", the matching order code
"Y01" or "Y02" and the required lock number.
Order code
Y01
Y02
In accordance with
the table of special
locks
No
Yes
Normal delivery time 25 working days
5 working days
Additional price
per unit
On request
On request
Ordering example
3SB30 00-4LD01-Z
Y01
Z = SSG18
3SB30 00-4LD01-Z
Y02
Z = SSG11
Available special locks
with order code "Y02"
When placing an order you must supplement the Order No. of
the matching key-operated switches with "-Z" and quote the order code "Y03".
Please enquire for price and delivery time.
Order No.
with order code
Key-operated switches
CES SSG 11 to SSG 15
10
BKS E1, E2, E7, E91)
3SB3. ..-4LD..-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-4MD01-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-4PD..-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-4QD..-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-4RD..-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-4SD..-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-5AD..-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-5BD01-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-5DD..-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-5ED01-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-5FD01-Z
Y02
3SB3. ..-5GD01-Z
Y02
Sub
group
key
Master
pass key
Main
group key
NSD0_00075
Example of master-pass key system
3SB3. ..-5FD51-Z
Y02
BKS E91)
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons
CES SSP 9
3SB3. ..-1KA20-Z
Y02
BKS E2, E7, E91)
3SB3. ..-1LA20-Z
Y02
1)
Delivery of these BKS key-operated switches (locks for VW) without key.
Ordering notes
• For all special locks, an additional price applies.
• The order code "Y01" or "Y02" must be quoted in accordance with the above table. Automated processing of the order with a defined delivery time can be guaranteed only for
correctly submitted orders.
• For applications in which access security is important and
several lock numbers are used, we recommend the use of
BKS or CES key-operated switches.
• Special locks for VW (E1, E2, ...) will be delivered without keys,
all others with 2 keys.
10/68
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Inscriptions
Laser inscriptions
■ Overview
Inscription of actuators and indicators
Ordering notes
Actuators and indicators of plastic as well as metal version can
be optionally inscribed with a laser.
When ordering, supplement the Order No. of the actuator or the
indicator light with "–Z" and an order code:
• Text line in upper/lower case, always upper case for beginning
of line (e.g. "Lift off"): Y10
• Text in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): Y11
• Text in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): Y12
• Text in upper/lower case, all words begin with capital letters
(e.g. "Lift Off"): Y15
• Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417: Y13
• Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: Y19
Additional price per unit for Y10 to Y19 on request.
When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in
addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German,
give the exact spelling and specify the language (see ordering
example 1).
Pushbutton (metal) with laser inscription
The actuators of the pushbuttons, illuminated pushbuttons,
mushroom pushbuttons and illuminated mushroom pushbuttons
can be inscribed as well as the lenses of the indicator lights.
Selector switches can be inscribed only if they are made of plastic (only one text line on the front ring).
In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned
to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower". For long words
you can also specify the end-of-line division.
Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to
ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3).
For special symbols (order code Y19), a CAD drawing in DXF
format can be submitted.
Ordering example 1
A round pushbutton with the inscription "Reset" is required:
3SB30 00–0AA41–Z
Y10
Z = Reset (English)
A square pushbutton inscribed with symbol No. 5389 according
to IEC 60417 is required:
3SB31 10–0AA31–Z
Y13
Z = 5389 IEC
Ordering example 3
A round pushbutton inscribed with symbol No. 1118 according
to ISO 7000 is required:
Pushbutton and selector switch (plastic) with laser inscription
Version
A letter height of 4 mm is used as standard for text inscriptions:
3SB30 00–0AA41–Z
Y13
Z = 1118 ISO
The typeface used is Arial. Other letter heights and typefaces
are possible, but must be specified when ordering.
For round buttons and lenses, the possible number of characters per line is:
• 10 characters for one line of text
• 8 characters for 2 lines of text
• 6 characters for 3 lines of text,
but 10 characters in the middle line
On square buttons and lenses, 10 characters are possible per
line.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/69
10
Ordering example 2
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Inscriptions
Inscriptions by laser printer
■ Overview
Label inscriptions
Using the Label Designer software, which can be downloaded
from the Internet, and the inscription labels for laser inscription
you can create your own customized labels with a standard laser
printer.
The self-adhesive or snap-on labels can be stuck or snapped
onto the corresponding label holders (see Name plates). Round
labels are provided for inserting in illuminated pushbuttons and
switches.
The labels are suitable for printing with one to three lines of text
or symbols.
For applications with more exacting requirements we recommend factory-printed inscription labels and insert labels (laserprinted or engraved depending on the type).
You can find the Label Designer software on the Internet at:
www.siemens.com/sirius-label-designer
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Color
DT Order No.
Insert labels
For inserting in round illuminated pushbuttons
and illuminated switches
Milky
A
Inscription labels 12.5 mm x 27 mm
For sticking onto label holder
White
Inscription labels 27 mm x 27 mm
For sticking onto label holder
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3901-2AB
100 480 units
102
A
3SB3902-2AA
100 480 units
102
White
A
3SB3903-2AA
100 480 units
102
Inscription labels 17.5 mm x 28 mm
For snapping onto label holder
White
A
3SB3905-2AA
100 720 units
102
Inscription labels 22 mm x 22 mm
For sticking onto enclosure
White
A
3SB3906-2AA
100 700 units
102
10
Labels for printing
10/70
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Inscriptions
Insert labels
■ Overview
Pushbuttons (clear) and illuminated pushbuttons with a flat button can be fitted with insert labels for identification purposes, but
indicator lights cannot.
These insert labels are made of clear, transparent plastic with
black inscription; they can be fitted in any 90° angle.
Inscriptions
The inscriptions have upper case initial letters. Graphic symbols,
including those not listed in the catalog, are according to
ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see page 10/72).
The insert labels without inscription are suitable for user marking
with permanent pen.
■ Selection and ordering data
PU (UNIT) = 100 (customized inscription: 1)
PS*
= 10 units (customized inscription: 1 unit)
PG
= 102
Inscription/Symbol
Symbol No.
DT Round range
Order No.
DT Square range
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Insert labels
For self-inscription
B
3SB1901-4AS
B
3SB3940-4AA
Ein
On
Aus
Off
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-4AB
3SB1901-4EB
3SB1901-4AC
3SB1901-4EC
B
B
B
B
3SB3940-4AB
3SB3940-4EB
3SB3940-4AC
3SB3940-4EC
Auf
Up
Ab
Down
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-4AD
3SB1901-4ED
3SB1901-4AE
3SB1901-4EE
B
B
B
B
3SB3940-4AD
3SB3940-4ED
3SB3940-4AE
3SB3940-4EE
Vor
Forward
Zurück
Reverse
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-4AF
3SB1901-4EF
3SB1901-4AG
3SB1901-4EG
B
-3SB3940-4EF
-3SB3940-4EG
Rechts
Right
Links
Left
B
C
B
C
3SB1901-4AH
3SB1901-4EH
3SB1901-4AJ
3SB1901-4EJ
Auf
Open
Zu
Close
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-4AD
3SB1901-4EP
3SB1901-4AL
3SB1901-4EQ
B
Schnell
Fast
Langsam
Slow
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-4AM
3SB1901-4ER
3SB1901-4AN
3SB1901-4ES
B
Betrieb
Running
Störung
Fault
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-4AP
3SB1901-4EV
3SB1901-4AQ
3SB1901-4EW
Einrichten
Reset
B
B
3SB1901-4AR
3SB1901-4EM
B
-3SB3940-4EM
Test
Start
Halt
Stop
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-4EN
3SB1901-4EK
3SB1901-4AK
3SB1901-4EL
B
B
B
-3SB3940-4EK
3SB3940-4AK
3SB3940-4EL
Blank
With inscription
B
-----
B
B
10
B
3SB3940-4AD
-3SB3940-4AL
-3SB3940-4AM
-3SB3940-4AN
---3SB3940-4AQ
--
With graphic symbol
O (Off)
5008 IEC
B
3SB1901-4MB
B
3SB3940-4MB
I (On)
5007 IEC
B
3SB1901-4MC
B
3SB3940-4MC
II (On)
--
B
3SB1901-4MD
B
3SB3940-4MD
Electric motor
0011 ISO
B
3SB1901-4PA
Motion in direction of arrow
5022 IEC
B
3SB1901-4NA
B
3SB3940-4NA
Increase, plus
5005 IEC
B
3SB1901-4NG
B
3SB3940-4NG
Decrease, minus
5006 IEC
B
3SB1901-4MC
B
3SB3940-4MC
--
With customized inscription
3SB1901-4AZ
For inscriptions or symbols see "Options"
3SB3940-4AZ
• Text line(s) or symbol with No.
D
K0Y, K1Y, K2Y,
K3Y or K5Y
B
K0Y, K1Y, K2Y,
K3Y or K5Y
• Any inscription or symbol
D
K9Y
B
K9Y
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/71
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Inscriptions
Insert labels
■ Options
Customized inscriptions
Ordering notes
The labels can be inscribed with text and symbols not listed in
the ordering data.
Append the following codes to the Order No.:
• Text line(s) in upper/lower case, upper case always for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift off"): K0Y
• Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): K1Y
• Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): K2Y
• Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper
case letters (e.g. "Lift Off"): K5Y
• Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417:
K3Y
• Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: K9Y
By default, a letter height of 4 mm (for a single line of text) or
3 mm (for 2 or 3 lines of text) is used for text inscriptions.
The typeface used is Arial. Other letter heights and typefaces
are possible, but must be specified when ordering.
For round insert labels, the maximum possible number of characters per line is:
• 10 characters for one line of text
• 8 characters for 2 lines of text
• 6 characters for 3 lines of text, but 10 characters in the middle
line
On square insert labels, 10 characters are possible per line.
Examples for customized inscription
When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in
addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German,
give the exact spelling and specify the language.
In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned
to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower". For long words
you can also specify the end-of-line division (see ordering
example 1).
Lift
Off
Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to
ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3).
Two-line inscription in upper/lower case lettering (K0Y)
Ordering example 1
LIFT
A label with 2 lines of text is required:
Single-line inscription in upper case lettering (K1Y)
lift
off
down
10
For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF
format can be submitted.
3SB19 01–4AZ
K1Y
Z1 = LIFT
Z2 = LOWER
Ordering example 2
A label inscribed with symbol No. 5011 according to IEC 60417
is required:
Three-line inscription in lower case letters (K2Y)
3SB19 01–4AZ
K3Y
Z = 5011 IEC
Ordering example 3
A label inscribed with symbol No. 1118 according to ISO 7000 is
required:
Symbol number 5011 according to IEC 60147 (K3Y)
Any symbol according to order form supplement (K9Y)
10/72
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
3SB19 01–4AZ
K3Y
Z = 1118 ISO
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Inscriptions
Name plates
■ Overview
The name plates consist of a black plastic label holder and an
inscription label (black with white print or silver-colored with
black print) for sticking or snapping in place. They are not suitable for EMERGENCY-STOP pushbuttons.
Note mounting dimensions!
Inscriptions
The inscriptions have upper case initial letters. The typeface is
Arial. Graphic symbols, including those not listed in the tables,
are according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see page 10/77).
Self-adhesive labels
There are 2 sizes available for the round and square ranges:
• Label holders 30 mm × 45 mm × 7 mm
with inscription label 12.5 mm × 27 mm.
• Label holders 30 mm × 60 mm × 7 mm
with inscription label 27 mm × 27 mm.
Snap-on labels
The following version is available for the round range:
• Label holders 29.8 mm × 51 mm × 3 mm
with inscription label 17.5 mm × 28 mm
(inscription area: 17.5 mm × 27 mm).
■ Selection and ordering data
PU (UNIT) = 100 (customized inscription: 1)
PS*
= 10 units (customized inscription: 1 unit)
PG
= 102
Inscriptions
DT Black
Order No.
DT Silver-colored
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Inscription labels, self-adhesive,
12.5 mm × 27 mm
For self-inscription
}
3SB3902-1AA
B
3SB1901-2AA
Ein
On
Aus
Off
B
B
B
B
3SB3902-1AB
3SB3902-1EB
3SB3902-1AC
3SB3902-1EC
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-2AB
3SB1901-2EB
3SB1901-2AC
3SB1901-2EC
Auf
Up
Ab
Down
B
B
B
B
3SB3902-1AD
3SB3902-1ED
3SB3902-1AE
3SB3902-1EE
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-2AD
3SB1901-2ED
3SB1901-2AE
3SB1901-2EE
Vor
Forward
Zurück
Reverse
B
B
B
B
3SB3902-1AF
3SB3902-1EF
3SB3902-1AG
3SB3902-1EG
B
3SB1901-2AF
-3SB1901-2AG
--
Rechts
Right
Links
Left
B
B
B
B
3SB3902-1AH
3SB3902-1EH
3SB3902-1AJ
3SB3902-1EJ
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-2AH
3SB1901-2EH
3SB1901-2AJ
3SB1901-2EJ
Auf
Open
Zu
Close
B
B
B
B
3SB3902-1AD
3SB3902-1EP
3SB3902-1AL
3SB3902-1EQ
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-2AD
3SB1901-2EP
3SB1901-2AL
3SB1901-2EQ
-----
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-2AM
3SB1901-2ER
3SB1901-2AN
3SB1901-2ES
Blank
Schnell
Fast
Langsam
Slow
B
Halt
Stop
Start
Test
B
B
B
B
3SB3902-1AK
3SB3902-1EK
3SB3902-1EL
3SB3902-1EN
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-2AK
3SB1901-2EK
3SB1901-2EL
3SB1901-2EN
Betrieb
Running
Störung
Fault
B
3SB3902-1AP
-3SB3902-1AQ
3SB3902-1EW
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-2AP
3SB1901-2EV
3SB1901-2AQ
3SB1901-2EW
---
B
B
3SB1901-2AR
3SB1901-2EM
3SB3902-1BC
3SB3902-1BA
3SB3902-1EU
---
B
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-2BC
3SB1901-2BA
3SB1901-2EU
3SB1901-2BE
3SB1901-2ET
B
B
Einrichten
Reset
Stop Start
Hand Auto
Man Auto
Hand O Auto
Man O Auto
B
B
B
10
With inscription
For label holders see page 10/76.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/73
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Inscriptions
Name plates
Inscriptions
DT Black
Order No.
DT Silver-colored
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Inscription labels, self-adhesive,
12.5 mm × 27 mm
With graphic symbol
O
I
II
III
B
B
3SB3902-1MB
3SB3902-1MC
---
B
B
C
B
3SB1901-2MB
3SB1901-2MC
3SB1901-2MD
3SB1901-2ME
OI
I O II
1 O 2
1 2
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3902-1MF
3SB3902-1MG
-3SB3902-1ML
3SB1901-2MF
3SB1901-2MG
3SB1901-2MK
--
↑
→
B
B
3SB3902-1NJ
3SB3902-1NA
B
B
3SB1901-2NA
3SB1901-2NJ
With customized inscription
3SB3902-1XZ
For inscriptions or symbols see "Options"
3SB1901-2XZ
• Text line(s)
C
K0Y
D
K0Y
• Text line(s) or symbol with No.
B
K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or
K5Y
D
K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or
K5Y
• Any inscription or symbol
B
K9Y
D
K9Y
Inscriptions
DT Black
Order No.
DT Silver-colored
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Inscription labels, self-adhesive,
27 mm × 27 mm
For self-inscription
B
3SB3903-1AA
Ein
On
Aus
Off
B
B
B
B
3SB3903-1AB
3SB3903-1EB
3SB3903-1AC
3SB3903-1EC
-----
Auf
Ab
B
B
3SB3903-1AD
3SB3903-1AE
---
Vor
Zurück
Rechts
Links
B
B
B
B
3SB3903-1AF
3SB3903-1AG
3SB3903-1AH
3SB3903-1AJ
-----
Auf
Zu
B
B
3SB3903-1AD
3SB3903-1AL
---
Halt
Start
B
B
3SB3903-1AK
3SB3903-1EL
---
Betrieb
Störung
B
B
3SB3903-1AP
3SB3903-1AQ
---
Stop Start
Hand Auto
B
B
3SB3903-1BC
3SB3903-1BA
---
O
B
3SB3903-1MB
--
OI
B
3SB3903-1MF
--
→
B
3SB3903-1NA
--
Blank
B
3SB1906-2AA
10
With inscription
With graphic symbol
With customized inscription
3SB3903-1XZ
For inscriptions or symbols see "Options"
3SB1906-2XZ
• Text line(s)
C
K0Y
D
K0Y
• Text line(s) or symbol with No.
B
K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or
K5Y
D
K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or
K5Y
• Any inscription or symbol
B
K9Y
D
K9Y
For label holders see page 10/76.
10/74
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Inscriptions
Name plates
Inscriptions
DT Black
Order No.
DT Silver-colored
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Inscription labels, for snapping on,
17.5 mm × 28 mm
For self-inscription
B
3SB3905-1AA
B
3SB1904-2AA
Ein
On
Aus
Off
B
B
B
B
3SB3905-1AB
3SB3905-1EB
3SB3905-1AC
3SB3905-1EC
B
B
B
B
3SB1904-2AB
3SB1904-2EB
3SB1904-2AC
3SB1904-2EC
Auf
Up
Ab
Down
B
B
B
B
3SB3905-1AD
3SB3905-1ED
3SB3905-1AE
3SB3905-1EE
B
3SB1904-2AD
-3SB1904-2AE
--
Vor
Forward
Zurück
Reverse
B
B
B
B
3SB3905-1AF
3SB3905-1EF
3SB3905-1AG
3SB3905-1EG
B
Rechts
Right
Links
B
B
3SB3905-1AH
3SB3905-1EH
--
B
Auf
Open
Zu
Close
B
B
B
B
3SB3905-1AD
3SB3905-1EP
3SB3905-1AL
3SB3905-1EQ
B
Halt
Stop
Start
Test
B
B
B
3SB3905-1AK
3SB3905-1EK
3SB3905-1EL
--
B
B
B
B
3SB1904-2AK
3SB1904-2EK
3SB1904-2EL
3SB1904-2EN
Betrieb
Running
Störung
Fault
B
B
B
B
3SB3905-1AP
3SB3905-1EV
3SB3905-1AQ
3SB3905-1EW
B
B
B
3SB1904-2AP
-3SB1904-2AQ
3SB1904-2EW
---
B
B
3SB1904-2AR
3SB1904-2EM
B
B
B
3SB3905-1BC
3SB3905-1BA
3SB3905-1EU
--
B
B
C
B
3SB1904-2BC
3SB1904-2BA
3SB1904-2EU
3SB1904-2ET
O
I
B
B
3SB3905-1MB
3SB3905-1MC
B
B
3SB1904-2MB
3SB1904-2MC
OI
I O II
1 O 2
B
3SB3905-1MF
---
B
B
B
3SB1904-2MF
3SB1904-2MG
3SB1904-2MK
→
↑
B
B
3SB3905-1NA
3SB3905-1NJ
B
B
3SB1904-2NA
3SB1904-2NJ
Blank
With inscription
Einrichten
Reset
Stop Start
Hand Auto
Man Auto
Man O Auto
B
B
B
B
B
3SB1904-2AF
-3SB1904-2AG
3SB1904-2EG
3SB1904-2AH
-3SB1904-2AJ
3SB1904-2AD
-3SB1904-2AL
--
10
With graphic symbol
With customized inscription
3SB3905-1XZ
For inscriptions or symbols see "Options"
3SB1904-2XZ
• Text line(s)
C
K0Y
D
K0Y
• Text line(s) or symbol with No.
B
K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or
K5Y
D
K1Y, K2Y, K3Y or
K5Y
• Any inscription or symbol
B
K9Y
D
K9Y
For label holders see page 10/76.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/75
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Inscriptions
Name plates
Version
DT Black
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Label holders for inscription labels 12.5 mm × 27 mm
For round range, flat
B
3SB3922-0AV
For potentiometer drives 3SB10 00-7CH071)
B
3SB3922-0AS
1
1 unit
102
For square range, flat
B
3SB3942-0AX
100
5 units
102
For round range, flat
B
3SB3923-0AV
100 10 units
102
For round range, raised
C
3SB3923-0AX
1 10 units
102
For potentiometer drives, flat
B
3SB3923-0AS
1
1 unit
102
For square range, flat
B
3SB3943-0AX
100
1 unit
102
}
3SB3925-0AV
100 10 units
102
100 10 units
102
3SB39 22-0AV
Label holders for inscription labels 27 mm × 27 mm
3SB39 23-0AV
Label holders for inscription labels 17.5 mm × 28 mm
For round design
3SB39 25-0AV
This label holder can also be used for pushbuttons with dust covers if the
front panel thickness of 3 mm is not exceeded.
10
1)
10/76
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Inscriptions
Name plates
■ Options
Customized inscriptions
Ordering notes
The labels can be inscribed with text and symbols not listed in
the ordering data.
Append the following codes to the Order No.:
• Text line(s) in upper/lower case, upper case always for beginning of line (e.g. "Lift off"): K0Y
• Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): K1Y
• Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): K2Y
• Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper
case letters (e.g. "Lift Off"): K5Y
• Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417:
K3Y
• Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: K9Y
The following letter heights are used as standard for text
inscriptions:
• Label size 12.5 mm × 27 mm: maximum 3 lines with letter
height 4 mm (1-line), 3.5 mm (2-line) or 2.5 mm (3-line)
• Label size 27 mm × 27 mm: maximum 5 lines with letter height
4 mm (1- to 5-line)
• Label size 17.5 mm × 28 mm: maximum 3 lines with letter
height 4 mm (1- and 2-line) or 3 mm (3-line)
Up to 11 characters per line are possible. The typeface used is
Arial. Other letter heights and typefaces are possible, but must
be specified when ordering.
Examples for customized inscription
Two-line inscription in upper/lower case lettering (K0Y)
When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in
addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German,
give the exact spelling and specify the language.
In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned
to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower". For long words
you can also specify the end-of-line division (see ordering
example 1).
Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to
ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3).
For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF
format can be submitted.
Single-line inscription in upper case lettering (K1Y)
Ordering example 1
A label with 2 lines of text is required:
Three-line inscription in lower case letters (K2Y)
3SB39 02–1XZ
K1Y
Z1 = LIFT
Z2 = LOWER
Ordering example 2
Symbol number 5011 according to IEC 60417 (K3Y)
10
A label inscribed with symbol No. 5011 according to IEC 60417
is required:
3SB39 02–1XZ
K3Y
Z = 5011 IEC
Ordering example 3
Any symbol according to order form supplement (K9Y)
A label inscribed with symbol No. 1118 according to ISO 7000 is
required:
3SB39 02–1XZ
K3Y
Z = 1118 ISO
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/77
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Buttons and lenses
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Color
DT Order No.
Buttons, flat
For round illuminated pushbuttons and
illuminated switches, plastic version
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB39 30-0CA6
Buttons, flat
For round pushbuttons and switches,
metal version
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
3SB39 30-0EA3
Buttons, raised
For round illuminated pushbuttons and
illuminated switches, plastic version
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3930-0CA2
3SB3930-0CA3
3SB3930-0CA4
3SB3930-0CA5
3SB3930-0CA6
3SB3930-0CA7
100
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3930-0EA1
3SB3930-0EA2
3SB3930-0EA3
3SB3930-0EA4
3SB3930-0EA5
3SB3930-0EA6
3SB3930-0EA7
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Red
Green
Clear
B
B
B
3SB3930-0DA2
3SB3930-0DA4
3SB3930-0DA7
1 10 units
1 10 units
1 10 units
102
102
102
Buttons, raised
For round pushbuttons and switches,
metal version
Black
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
D
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3930-0FA1
3SB3930-0FA2
3SB3930-0FA3
3SB3930-0FA4
3SB3930-0FA5
3SB3930-0FA6
3SB3930-0FA7
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Buttons, flat
For round illuminated pushbuttons and
illuminated switches, metal version
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3930-0GA0
3SB3930-0GA2
3SB3930-0GA3
3SB3930-0GA4
3SB3930-0GA5
3SB3930-0GA6
3SB3930-0GA7
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Buttons, flat, solvent-resistant2),
For round illuminated pushbuttons and
switches, metal version
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3930-0GA20-0PA0
3SB3930-0GA30-0PA0
3SB3930-0GA40-0PA0
3SB3930-0GA50-0PA0
3SB3930-0GA60-0PA0
3SB3930-0GA70-0PA0
100
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
Buttons, raised
For round illuminated pushbuttons and
illuminated switches, metal version
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3930-0HA0
3SB3930-0HA2
3SB3930-0HA3
3SB3930-0HA4
3SB3930-0HA5
3SB3930-0HA6
3SB3930-0HA7
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Lenses, smooth
For round indicator lights, plastic and
metal version
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
C
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3930-6BA0
3SB3930-6BA2
3SB3930-6BA3
3SB3930-6BA4
3SB3930-6BA5
3SB3930-6BA6
3SB3930-6BA7
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Lenses with concentric rings
For round indicator lights, plastic and
metal version
Amber
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3930-6CA0
3SB3930-6CA2
3SB3930-6CA3
3SB3930-6CA4
3SB3930-6CA5
3SB3930-6CA6
3SB3930-6CA7
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
102
Buttons, flat
For square illuminated pushbuttons and
illuminated switches, plastic version
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3950-0CA2
3SB3950-0CA3
3SB3950-0CA4
3SB3950-0CA5
3SB3950-0CA6
3SB3950-0CA7
100
100
100
100
100
100
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
Lenses, smooth
For square indicator lights, plastic version
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
Clear
B
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3950-6AA2
3SB3950-6AA3
3SB3950-6AA4
3SB3950-6AA5
3SB3950-6AA6
3SB3950-6AA7
1
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
Buttons and lenses for round version1)
3SB39 30-0DA4
3SB39 30-0FA4
10
3SB39 30-0GA3
3SB39 30-0HA4
3SB39 30-6BA3
3SB39 30-6CA3
Buttons and lenses for square version
3SB39 50-0CA6
3SB39 50-6AA2
1)
In scope of supply of pushbuttons or indicator lights.
2)
Not suitable for laser inscription.
10/78
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Lamps, acoustic signal transformers and keys
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
24 AC/DC
Clear
A
3SB1902-0AY
1 10 units
102
Incandescent lamps 2 W
Length up to 28 mm,
max. bulb diameter 10 mm
6 AC/DC
12 AC/DC
24 AC/DC
30 AC/DC
48 AC/DC
60 AC/DC
Clear
A
A
A
B
B
A
3SX1342
3SX1343
3SX1344
3SB1902-2AF
3SB1902-1AP
3SR9424
1
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
Incandescent lamps 2.6 W
Length 28 mm,
bulb diameter 10 mm
110 ... 130
AC/DC2)
Clear
}
3SX1731
1
10 units
102
Multi-incandescent lamps 1.2 W
Endurance 25 000 h,
high resistance to vibration
24 AC/DC
B
3SB1902-2BU
1 10 units
102
LED lamps, super-bright
Length up to 28 mm,
max. bulb diameter 10 mm,
max. operational current 15 mA
24 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
}
B
}
B
}
3SB3901-1CA
3SB3901-1BA
3SB3901-1DA
3SB3901-1PA
3SB3901-1QA
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
48 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3901-1CC
3SB3901-1BC
3SB3901-1DC
3SB3901-1PC
3SB3901-1QC
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
130 AC,
70 ... 90 DC,
if X1 at "+"
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3901-1CD
3SB3901-1BD
3SB3901-1DD
3SB3901-1PD
3SB3901-1QD
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
230 AC,
110 ... 160
DC,
if X1 at "+"
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3901-1CF
3SB3901-1BF
3SB3901-1DF
3SB3901-1PF
3SB3901-1QF
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
230 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3901-1CG
3SB3901-1BG
3SB3901-1DG
3SB3901-1PG
3SB3901-1QG
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
LED lamps
Length up to 28 mm,
max. bulb diameter 10 mm,
max. operational current 15 mA
22 ... 32 DC
Red
Yellow
Green
D
D
D
3SB1902-4AJ
3SB1902-4BJ
3SB1902-4CJ
1 10 units
1 10 units
1 10 units
102
102
102
LED lamps, flashing (1.4 Hz)
Length up to 28 mm,
bulb diameter 10 mm,
operational current 24 ... 29 mA
24 DC
Red
Yellow
Green
B
C
C
3SB1902-4LC
3SB1902-4MC
3SB1902-4NC
1 10 units
1 10 units
1 10 units
102
102
102
Clear
Clear
Green
A
A
C
3SX1703
3SX1701
3SX1702
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
}
3SB1902-2AD
1
1 unit
102
Glow lamps3)
110 AC
Length 28 mm, bulb diameter 10 mm, 220 AC
operational current approx. 1.8 mA
220 AC
3SX1 703
Lamp extractors
For lamps with BA 9s base
3SB19 02-2AD
1)
Essential accessories when using lampholders with BA 9s base and delivery without lamp.
2)
Also for 230 V when used with a 3SB34 00-1C voltage reducer.
3)
Due to the inherent orange color of glow lamps and their lower luminance
level compared to incandescent lamps, it is recommended that they
should only be used with clear or red screw lenses and in areas where
ambient light levels are not very high.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/79
10
Incandescent lamps 1.2 W
Length up to 28 mm,
max. bulb diameter 10 mm
3SB39 01-1PA
3SB19 02-4MC
DT Order No.
V
Lamps, BA 9s bases1)
3SB19 02-0AY
Rated voltage Color
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Lamps, acoustic signal transformers and keys
Version
Rated voltage Color
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
V
Lamps, Wedge bases1)
Incandescent lamps
Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d, 1.0 W
6 AC/DC
12 AC/DC
24 AC/DC
30 AC/DC
48 AC/DC
60 AC/DC
Clear
C
B
}
A
B
B
3SB2908-1AA
3SB2908-1AB
3SB2908-1AC
3SB2908-1AD
3SB2908-1AE
3SB2908-1AF
100
100
100
100
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
102
LED lamps, super-bright
Wedge base W2 × 4.6 d,
operational current 10 mA
24 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
White
Blue
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3901-1SB
3SB3901-1RB
3SB3901-1TB
3SB3901-1UB
3SB2908-1BD
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
28 AC/DC
Red
Yellow
Green
White
Blue
B
B
B
B
D
3SB3901-1SE
3SB3901-1RE
3SB3901-1TE
3SB3901-1UE
3SB3901-1VE
1
1
1
1
1
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
10 units
102
102
102
102
102
Lamp extractors
For lamps with bases W2 × 4.6 d
}
3SB2908-2AB
1
1 unit
102
Lamp adapters
For fitting a lamp
with a wedge base socket
into a BA 9s lampholder
C
3SB1902-1AU
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB1902-2BN
1
1 unit
102
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB29 08-1AE
3SB39 01-1SB
3SB39 01-1VE
3SB29 08-2AB
3SB19 02-1AU
Acoustic signal transformers, BA 9s base
Acoustic signal transformers
For acoustic signaling devices2)
operational current 25 mA, 0.6 W,
sound pressure 80 dB/10 cm
24 ... 28 DC
3SB19 02-2BN
1)
Can be used with lamp adapters in lampholders with BA 9s base.
2)
For increased protection, the IP65 acoustic signaling device (complete
unit) can be used.
10
Version Lock
Color
Manufacturer
Lock No.
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
Keys for actuators1)2)
3SY1 054
Ronis
SB 30
B
3SB3910-4A
1
1 unit
102
BKS
S1
A
3SY1066
1
1 unit
102
CES
LSG 1
SSG 10
SSP 9
B
B
A
3SB1910-2F
3SY1054
3SY1052
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
O.M.R.
73038
73037
73034
73033
C
B
B
D
3SB1910-2L
3SB1910-2M
3SB1910-2N
3SB1910-2P
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
1)
Included in scope of supply of the key-operated switches and the
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons with lock.
2)
Also available with special lock. Supplement Order No. with "-Z" and
quote the required lock in plain text.
Additional price on request.
This does not include locks for VW and main and general locking systems.
10/80
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
Light blue
Red
Black
Yellow
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Protective covers
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Use
Color
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Protective caps1), degree of protection IP67
Material: elastolan
Protective caps
For round version
Flat button (plastic)
Clear
B
3SB3921-0AJ
1
1 unit
102
Flat button (metal),
raised button (plastic)
Clear
B
3SB3921-0AM
1
1 unit
102
• PVC
Raised button (metal)
Clear
C
3SB1902-2AN
1
1 unit
102
Protective caps
For square version
Flat button (plastic)
Clear
B
3SB3941-0AJ
1
1 unit
102
Flat button (plastic)
Clear
B
3SB3921-0AH
1
1 unit
102
Flat button (metal),
raised button (plastic)
Clear
B
3SB1902-0AK
1
1 unit
102
Raised button (metal)
Clear
B
3SB1902-0AN
1
1 unit
102
Protective caps
For round version
Selector switch (plastic and
metal,
normal handle)
Clear
B
3SB3921-0BA
1
1 unit
102
Protective caps
For round version
Mushroom push-pull button,
Ø 40 mm (plastic and metal)
Clear
B
3SB1902-2BH
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
Clear
pushbutton, Ø 40 mm (plastic and
metal)
B
3SB3921-0BU
1
1 unit
102
Flat button (plastic)
B
3SB3941-0AH
1
1 unit
102
3SB39 21-0AJ
3SB39 41-0AJ
Material: silicone
Protective caps
For round version
3SB39 21-0AH
3SB19 02-0AK
10
3SB19 02-0AN
3SB39 21-0BA
3SB19 02-2BH
3SB39 21-0BU
Protective caps
For square version
Clear
3SB39 41-0AH
1)
Not for mounting in 3SB38 enclosure with 3SB34 20 or 3SB34 23 contact
blocks and lampholders for floor mounting.
Not to be used with label holder.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/81
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Protective covers
Version
Use
Color
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Other protective caps1)
Flat button (plastic)
Black
B
3SB1902-0AL
1
1 unit
102
Flat button (metal),
raised button (plastic)
Clear
B
3SB1902-2AR
1
1 unit
102
BKS, CES, O.M.R. key-operated
switch
Clear
B
3SB3921-0BT
1
1 unit
102
Protective collars for EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
EMERGENCY-STOP2) pushbutton
For round version
without lock
Yellow
}
3SB3921-0AK
1
1 unit
102
Gray
C
3SB3921-0AP
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbutton
with key-operated switch
Yellow
B
3SB3921-0AX
1
1 unit
102
Protective collars for 3SB3...-1AA20 EMERGENCYEMERGENCY-STOP STOP mushroom pushbutton
for 5 padlocks2)
For round version
Yellow
}
3SB3921-0CG
1
1 unit
102
Sun collars
For round version
Black
B
3SB3921-0AS
1
1 unit
102
Sealable caps
For round version
3SB19 02-0AL
3SB19 02-2AR
Dust covers
For use in dusty
environments
3SB39 21-0BT
Protective collars for front plates
3SB39 21-0AX
10
3SB39 21-0CG
Illuminated pushbuttons
3SB39 21-0AS
Blanking plugs for spare command points for front plates
Blanking plugs
For round version
Plastic version
Black
}
3SB3921-0AA
1 10 units
102
Blanking plugs
For square version
Plastic version
Black
B
3SB3941-0AA
1
1 unit
102
Blanking plugs
(plastic)
for round version
Metal version
Aluminized
B
3SB1902-0AQ
1 10 units
102
3SB39 21-0AA
3SB39 41-0AA
3SB19 02-0AQ
1)
Unsuitable for mounting in 3SB38 enclosures.
Not to be used with label holder.
2)
The protective collar must only be used to protect against inadvertent actuating and must be fitted to allow unimpeded actuation of the EMERGENCYSTOP mushroom pushbutton.
10/82
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Miscellaneous accessories
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Use
Inscriptions
DT Order No.
B
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3921-0DY
1
1 unit
102
Yellow name plates for EMERGENCY-STOP
For use on front plates
Name plates, round
Self-adhesive,
external diameter
60 mm,
internal diameter
23 mm
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
(round version)
Blank
Name plates, round
Self-adhesive,
external diameter
80 mm,
internal diameter
23 mm
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
(round version)
Blank
B
3SB3921-0AB
1
1 unit
102
4 languages,
de1), en, it, es
B
3SB3921-0BW
1
1 unit
102
NOT-HALT
B
3SB3921-0AC
1
1 unit
102
NOT-AUS
B
3SB3921-0CK
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY
STOP
B
3SB3921-0AD
1
1 unit
102
ARRET
D’URGENCE
B
3SB3921-0AG
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENZA
B
3SB3921-0AN
1
1 unit
102
Blank
B
3SB3941-0AB
1
1 unit
102
NOT-HALT
B
3SB3941-0AC
1
1 unit
102
NOT-AUS
B
3SB3941-0BX
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY
STOP
B
3SB3941-0AD
1
1 unit
102
3SB39 21-0AC
3SB39 21-0DA
Name plates, round
1 mm thick,
external diameter
75 mm,
internal diameter
22.5 mm
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
(round version)
Blank
B
3SB1902-2BA
1
1 unit
102
NOT-HALT
B
3SB1902-2BB
1
1 unit
102
NOT-AUS
B
3SB3921-0CH
1
1 unit
102
Name plates, round
Self-adhesive,
external diameter
60 mm,
internal diameter
23 mm2)
EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom pushbutton
(round version)
Blank
B
3SB3921-0DA
1
1 unit
102
NOT-HALT
B
3SB3921-0DK
1
1 unit
102
NOT-AUS
B
3SB3921-0DC
1
1 unit
102
EMERGENCY
STOP
B
3SB3921-0DD
1
1 unit
102
Illuminated,
suitable as signaling
device for
EMERGENCY-STOP,
with plug-in connection for 24 V AC/DC3)
10
3SB39 21-0BW
Name plates, round EMERGENCY-STOP
Self-adhesive,
mushroom pushbuttons
external diameter
(square version)
80 mm,
cutout 26 mm × 26 mm
Inscription labels
Inscription labels
For supporting dust
resistance
Contact blocks
B
3SB3901-0CH
100
10 units
102
Unit labeling plates
Contact blocks
B
3TX4210-0H
100 100 units
101
3SB39 01-0CH
3TX4 210-0H
1)
With German inscription "NOT-HALT".
2)
For front panel thickness of max. 4 mm.
3)
The illuminated label can also be operated through the AS-Interface
F adapter (see page 10/68).
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/83
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Miscellaneous accessories
Version
Use
DT Order No.
Pushbuttons, push-pull buttons, mushroom pushbuttons
with front plate mounting
}
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3901-0AB
100 20 units
102
Holders with pressure plate
Selector switches, key-oper- }
For actuating the central contact ated switches and twin pushblock of 3 contact blocks
buttons with front plate
mounting
3SB3901-0AC
100 10 units
102
Pressure plates
Selector switches and keyFor actuating the central contact operated switches for use on
block of 3 contact blocks
PCBs or with floor mounting
B
3SB3901-0AW
100 10 units
102
}
3SB3931-0AA
1 10 units
102
Holders
For plastic version, square
B
3SB3951-0AA
1
1 unit
102
Holders
For metal version, round
}
3SB3931-0AC
1 10 units
102
Grounding screws
For grounding metal actuators
for fitting in front plates made of
non-conducting materials
B
3SB3921-0BD
100 50 units
102
Holders and pressure plates
Holders
For snapping on 3 blocks1)
3SB39 01-0AB
3SB39 01-0AC
3SB39 01-0AW
Holders for commanding and signaling elements2)
Holders
For plastic version, round
As-supplied state for front
panel thickness 1 ... 4 mm
3SB39 31-0AA
10
3SB39 51-0AA
3SB39 31-0AC
3SB39 21-0BD
1)
The holder for illuminated commanding devices is included in the scope of
supply.
2)
The matching holder for actuators and indicators is included in the scope
of supply (exception: Order with order code "B01").
10/84
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Accessories and Spare Parts
Miscellaneous accessories
Version
Use
Color
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Tools
Blanking tools
26 mm × 26 mm,
for square version
B
3SB3941-0AF
1
1 unit
102
Hole drilling templates
For 30 mm × 30 mm grid,
horizontal,
for round and square versions
C
3SB1902-2BG
1
1 unit
102
Mounting tools
For buttons and lenses, metal version
B
3SB3921-0BC
1
1 unit
102
Mounting tools
For potentiometer drives and for
pushbuttons with extended stroke
C
3SX1707
1
1 unit
102
Dismantling tools
Blocks with
For contact blocks and lampholders screw terminals
B
3SB3901-0CB
1
1 unit
102
Dismantling tools
With springFor contact blocks and lampholders type terminals
C
3SB3901-0CG
1
1 unit
102
C
3SB3921-0AU
1
1 unit
102
1
1 unit
102
100 10 units
102
3SB39 41-0AF
3SB19 02-2BG
3SB39 21-0BC
3SX1 707
Various accessories
Single frames
For square design of the round
version
Black
3SB39 21-0AU
Adapter parts
Adapters for 30.5 mm mounting hole,
comprising a metal disk with an
adhesive layer on one side,
degree of protection IP65
As thrust ring
for a thin
molded-plastic
front plate
B
3SB3921-0AE
Printed circuit board holders
For mounting the command devices
on the printed circuit board (screw is
included in the scope of supply)
Contact blocks
and lampholders for solder
connection
B
3SB3901-0AA
Extension plungers
For compensation of the distance
between a pushbutton and the
unlatching button of an overload
relay
Pushbuttons
with extended
stroke
A
3SX1335
3SB39 21-0AE
3SB39 01-0AA
1
1 unit
102
3SX1 335
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/85
10
3SB39 01-0CB
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
General data
■ Overview
For AS-Interface enclosures see page 10/96.
Enclosures with standard fittings
I
H
G
E
B
C2
NSD0_00049b
C1
A
Enclosures with standard and customized equipment
Enclosed pushbuttons and indicator lights are used as hand operated control devices for separately allocated control units and
cabinets.
F
D
Enclosures with handle are available for suspension (e.g. for
crane control units).
A
B
C1
C2
D
E
F
G
H
I
The enclosed pushbuttons and indicator lights are available with
conventional controls as well as for connection to the
AS-Interface bus system.
The following versions are available:
• Enclosure with standard fittings
with 1 to 3 command points
• Enclosure with customized equipment
with 1 to 6 command points
• Empty enclosures (individual parts must be ordered
separately).
Standards
Customer-specific enclosures
10
Top part of enclosure
Inscription labels
Pushbutton
Indicator light
Holder
Contact designations
Contact blocks, lampholders for floor mounting
Bottom part of enclosure
Identification letters for the command points
Identification number
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1
On request enclosures with more than 6 command points can
also be supplied with AS-Interface connection.
Use the configurator for selection.
■ Application
The devices are climate-proof (KTW 24) according to
EN ISO 6270-2 and suitable for stationary use (weatherprotected) and for use in marine applications.
■ Technical specifications
Type
3SB38 0.-0, 3SB38 0.-1
3SB38 0.-2, 3SB38 0.-3
Enclosures
Enclosure material
Plastic
Metal
Actuators and indicators
Plastic, round
Metal, round
Degree of protection acc. to IEC 60529
IP65
IP67 and NEMA Type 4
Climatic withstand capability acc. to EN ISO 6270-2
KTW 24
Shock resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-27
for half-sine shock type, 11 ms shock duration
• Devices without incandescent lamp
≤ 50 g
• Devices with incandescent lamp
≤ 30 g
Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 60068-2-6
• Acceleration at frequency 20 ... 200 Hz
10/86
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
5g
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
Enclosures with standard fittings
■ Overview
Enclosures with standard fittings are available with:
• 1 to 3 command points
• Operational voltage up to 400 V
• Vertical mounting type
• Plastic enclosures are equipped with plastic actuators and indicators, metal enclosures are equipped with metal actuators
and indicators
• Contact blocks and lampholders for floor mounting (are
snapped into the enclosure base). Screw terminals (box terminals) as standard; some versions also with spring-type terminals (Order No. ends with -0CC0).
The actuators/indicators are fixed with an enclosure nut. If required it can be disassembled with a 27 mm socket wrench or
with a 3SX17 07 ring nut wrench.
Color of enclosure cover:
• Gray, RAL 7035, or
• Yellow, RAL 1004
Color of enclosure base:
• Black, RAL 9005
■ Selection and ordering data
Equipment
Contact block
function
Number of DT Screw terminals
command
points
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Plastic enclosures with standard fittings
Cable entry top and bottom each 1 x M20
A = Pushbutton green, label "I"
1 NO
1
B
3SB3801-0DA3
1
1 unit
102
A = Pushbutton red, label "O"
1 NC
1
B
3SB3801-0DB3
1
1 unit
102
A = Pushbutton white, label "I"
1 NO
1
B
3SB3801-0DD3
1
1 unit
102
A = Pushbutton black, label "O"
1 NC
1
B
3SB3801-0DE3
1
1 unit
102
3SB38 01-0DA3
3SB38 01-0.F3
1 NC
2)
1
B
3SB3801-0DG3
1
1 unit
102
2 NC
2)
1
B
3SB3801-0EG3
1
1 unit
102
• With yellow top part,
with protective collar1)
1 NC
2)
1
B
3SB3801-0DF3
1
1 unit
102
2 NC
2)
1
B
3SB3801-0EF3
1
1 unit
102
B = Pushbutton green, label "I"
A = Pushbutton red, label "O"
1 NO,
1 NC
2
B
3SB3802-0DA3
1
1 unit
102
B = Pushbutton white, label "I"
A = Pushbutton black, label "O"
1 NO,
1 NC
2
B
3SB3802-0DB3
1
1 unit
102
C = Indicator light clear,
label without inscription,
B = Pushbutton green, label "I",
A = Pushbutton red, label "O"
BA 9s3),
3
B
3SB3803-0DA3
1
1 unit
102
C = Pushbutton black, label "II"
B = Pushbutton black, label "I",
A = Pushbutton red, label "O"
1 NO,
1 NO,
1 NC
3
C
3SB3803-0DB3
1
1 unit
102
C = Indicator light clear,
label without inscription,
B = Pushbutton white, label "I",
A = Pushbutton black, label "O"
BA 9s3),
3
C
3SB3803-0DC3
1
1 unit
102
• With yellow top part,
without protective collar
3SB38 02-0DA3
1 NO,
1 NC
1 NO,
1 NC
3SB38 03-0DA3
1)
The protective collar must only be used to protect against inadvertent actuating and must be fitted to allow unimpeded access to the EMERGENCYSTOP mushroom pushbutton.
2)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
3)
Only lampholder; order lamp separately.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/87
10
A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with positive latching according to
ISO 13850 and rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
Enclosures with standard fittings
Equipment
Number of DT Screw terminals
command
points
Spring-type
terminals3)
Contact
block
function
Order No.
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Metal enclosures with standard fittings
Cable entry top and bottom each 1 x M20
A = Pushbutton green, label "I"
1 NO
1
B
3SB3801-2DA3
1
1 unit
102
A = Pushbutton red, label "O"
1 NC
1
B
3SB3801-2DB3
1
1 unit
102
A = Pushbutton white, label "I"
1 NO
1
B
3SB3801-2DD3
1
1 unit
102
A = Pushbutton black, label "O"
1 NC
1
B
3SB3801-2DE3
1
1 unit
102
3SB38 01-2DB3
A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm,
with positive latching according to
ISO 13850 and rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism
3SB38 01-2.F3
• With yellow top part,
without protective collar
- With M12 socket
• With yellow top part,
with protective collar1)
1 NC
2)
1
B
3SB3801-2DG3
1
1 unit
102
2 NC
2)
1
B
3SB3801-2EG3
1
1 unit
102
2 NC
2)3)
1
C
3SB3801-2EG10-0CC0
1
1 unit
102
1 NC
2)
1
B
3SB3801-2DF3
1
1 unit
102
2 NC
2)
1
B
3SB3801-2EF3
1
1 unit
102
2 NC
2)
1
B
3SB3801-2EA30
1
1 unit
102
2 NC
2)3)
1
B
3SB3801-2EA30-0CC0
1
1 unit
102
A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom
pushbuttons, Ø 60 mm,
with positive latching according to
ISO 13850 and rotate-to-unlatch
mechanism
3SB38 01-2EB30
• With yellow top part,
with protective collar for
5 padlocks
A = mushroom pushbutton,
Ø 60 mm, black,
with positive latching and rotate-tounlatch mechanism
10
3SB38 02-2DA3
3SB38 03-2DA3
• With gray top part,
with protective collar for
5 padlocks
2 NC3)
1
B
3SB3801-2EB30-0CC0
1
1 unit
102
B = Pushbutton green, label "I"
A = Pushbutton red, label "O"
1 NO,
1 NC
2
B
3SB3802-2DA3
1
1 unit
102
B = Pushbutton white, label "I"
A = Pushbutton black, label "O"
1 NO,
1 NC
2
B
3SB3802-2DB3
1
1 unit
102
C = Indicator light clear,
label without inscription,
B = Pushbutton green, label "I",
A = Pushbutton red, label "O"
BA 9s4),
3
B
3SB3803-2DA3
1
1 unit
102
1 NO,
1 NC
C = Pushbutton black, label "II"
B = Pushbutton black, label "I",
A = Pushbutton red, label "O"
1 NO,
1 NO,
1 NC
3
B
3SB3803-2DB3
1
1 unit
102
C = Indicator light clear,
label without inscription,
B = Pushbutton white, label "I",
A = Pushbutton black, label "O"
BA 9s4),
3
B
3SB3803-2DC3
1
1 unit
102
1 NO,
1 NC
3SB38 03-2DB3
1)
The protective collar must only be used to protect against inadvertent actuating and must be fitted to allow unimpeded access to the EMERGENCYSTOP mushroom pushbutton.
2)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
-0CC0: Contact blocks with spring-type terminals.
4)
Only lampholder; order lamp separately.
3)
10/88
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
Empty enclosures
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Number of DT Order No.
command
points
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Empty enclosures, plastic
Cable entry top and bottom
each 1 x M20 for 1 to 3 command points,
each 1 x M25 for 4 and 6 command points
1
2
3
4
6
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3801-0AA3
3SB3802-0AA3
3SB3803-0AA3
3SB3804-0AA3
3SB3806-0AA3
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
• With yellow top part,
without protective collar
1
B
3SB3801-0AB3
1
1 unit
102
• With yellow top part,
with protective collar1)
1
B
3SB3801-0AD3
1
1 unit
102
1
2
3
4
6
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3801-2AA3
3SB3802-2AA3
3SB3803-2AA3
3SB3804-2AA3
3SB3806-2AA3
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
• With yellow top part,
without protective collar
1
B
3SB3801-2AB3
1
1 unit
102
• With yellow top part,
with protective collar1)
1
B
3SB3801-2AD3
1
1 unit
102
• With gray top part,
with protective collar
1
B
3SB3801-2AE3
1
1 unit
102
• With yellow top part,
1
with protective collar for 3 padlocks, for mushroom
Ø 40 mm, can be locked (BKS, CES, O.M.R.)
B
3SB3801-2EC3
1
1 unit
102
For contact blocks, lampholders and accessories
with snap-on floor mounting, also single-pole front
plate blocks can be used (switching state is
maintained upon opening), with gray top part
3SB38 02-0AA3
For EMERGENCY-STOP, for contact blocks, lampholders and accessories with snap-on floor mounting, also single-pole front plate blocks can be used
(switching state is maintained upon opening)
3SB38 01-0AB3
Empty enclosures, metal
Cable entry top and bottom
each 1 x M20 for 1 to 3 command points,
each 1 x M25 for 4 and 6 command points
For contact blocks, lampholders and accessories
with snap-on floor mounting, also single-pole front
plate blocks can be used (switching state is
maintained upon opening), with gray top part
3SB38 04-2AA3
3SB38 01-2AB3
3SB38 01-2AD3
3SB38 01-2EC3
1)
The protective collar must only be used to protect against inadvertent actuating and must be fitted to allow unimpeded access to the EMERGENCYSTOP mushroom pushbutton.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/89
10
For EMERGENCY-STOP, for contact blocks, lampholders and accessories with snap-on floor mounting, also single-pole front plate blocks can be used
(switching state is maintained upon opening)
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
Customer-specific enclosures
■ Overview
Customized enclosures are available with:
• 1 to 6 command points
• Operational voltage up to 400 V.
One command point comprises:
• 1 actuator or indicator
• Up to 3 contact blocks or up to 2 contact blocks +
1 lampholder
• 1 inscription label
For plastic enclosures the command points are equipped as
standard with plastic actuators and indicators, for metal enclosures they are equipped with metal actuators and indicators.
For routing the cable in, one hole for M20 (for 1 to 3 command
points) or for M25 (for 4 or 6 command points) is provided at the
top and bottom.
Ordering notes (selection by configurator)
To order customized enclosures with the 3SB3 control devices,
use the 3SB configurator to select the blocks for equipping. An
electronic order form will be generated for the additional options.
The configurator is available in the interactive catalog CA 01 on
DVD or in the Industry Mall on the Internet:
www.siemens.com/industrymall
Supplement the Order No. with the order code "K0Y"
(as already listed in the selection table).
The list price of the complete enclosure is generated in the configurator for the customized equipment.
Please send the resulting electronic order form along with your
order by e-mail to our Competence Center at
sirius-attach.aud@siemens.com
If you are unable to access either catalog, please contact our
Technical Assistance.
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Number of DT Order No.
command
points
With contact blocks and lampholders for floor
mounting
1
2
3
4
6
C
C
C
B
B
With single-pole contact blocks and lampholders for 1
front plate mounting
2
3
4
6
With contact blocks and lampholders for floor
mounting
Price
per PU1)
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3801-0AZK0Y
3SB3802-0AZK0Y
3SB3803-0AZK0Y
3SB3804-0AZK0Y
3SB3806-0AZK0Y
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
C
C
C
B
B
3SB3801-1AZK0Y
3SB3802-1AZK0Y
3SB3803-1AZK0Y
3SB3804-1AZK0Y
3SB3806-1AZK0Y
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
1
2
3
4
6
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3801-2AZK0Y
3SB3802-2AZK0Y
3SB3803-2AZK0Y
3SB3804-2AZK0Y
3SB3806-2AZK0Y
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
With single-pole contact blocks and lampholders for 1
front plate mounting
2
3
4
6
C
C
C
C
C
3SB3801-3AZK0Y
3SB3802-3AZK0Y
3SB3803-3AZK0Y
3SB3804-3AZK0Y
3SB3806-3AZK0Y
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Suspended pushbuttons
With holding plate and handle, customized
equipment
D
3SB3887-1AZK0Y
1
1 unit
102
Plastic enclosures
3SB38 03-.AZ
10
Metal enclosures
3SB38 03-.AZ
1)
max. 6
The prices depend on the equipment selected in the configurator.
10/90
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
Contact blocks and lampholders
■ Selection and ordering data
For self-equipping of the enclosures
Version
Rated voltage/
Diagram
Operating travel/color DT Screw terminals
Contact closed
Order No.
Contact open
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Contact blocks for floor mounting
Contact blocks with one contact
3
1 NO with gold-plated
contacts
1 NC with gold-plated
contacts
1)
1
2
1
1 unit
102
3SB3420-0BA
1
1 unit
102
}
3SB3420-0C
1
1 unit
102
C
3SB3420-0CA
1
1 unit
102
}
3SB3420-1A
1
1 unit
102
Clear
B
3SB3420-1C
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
B
}
}
B
}
3SB3420-1PA
3SB3420-1PB
3SB3420-1PC
3SB3420-1PD
3SB3420-1PE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
D
B
3SB3420-1QA
3SB3420-1QB
3SB3420-1QC
3SB3420-1QD
3SB3420-1QE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3420-1RA
3SB3420-1RB
3SB3420-1RC
3SB3420-1RD
3SB3420-1RE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Blue
Green/Yellow
B
B
B
3SB3901-0AG
3SB3901-0AH
3SB3901-0AJ
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
2
3
4
2,3
NSD0_00017
NSD00007
3SB34 20-0B
1)
3SB3420-0B
B
3-4
0 1
mm
4
1 NC
}
NSD0_00015
NSD00006
1 NO
1-2
0 1
mm
2
3
4
1,6
BA 9s lampholders
Without lamp
Acc. to lamp
X1
(L+)
X2
(L-)
NSD00003
230/240 V AC
With integrated voltage
reducer and with 130 V lamp
X2
X1
(3SX1 731)2)
3SB34 20-1A
NSD00042
Lampholders with
integrated LED
24 V AC/DC
X1
k
X2
k
+
NSD0_01292b
110 V AC
X1
k
3SB34 20-1PE
k
+
X2
X1
k
k
+
X2
NSD0_01296b
Fixpoint terminals
3SB39 01-0AH
1)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
2)
Only use with this lamp.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/91
10
NSD0_01296b
230 V AC
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
Contact blocks and lampholders
Version
Rated voltage/
Diagram
Operating travel/color DT Spring-type
terminals
Contact closed
Order No.
Contact open
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Price
per PU
Contact blocks for floor mounting
Contact blocks with one contact
3
1 NO with gold-plated
contacts
1 NC with gold-plated
contacts
1)
1
2
Lampholders with
integrated LED
1
1 unit
102
3SB3423-0BA
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3423-0C
1
1 unit
102
B
3SB3423-0CA
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
Red
Green
Blue
White
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3423-1PA
3SB3423-1PB
3SB3423-1PC
3SB3423-1PD
3SB3423-1PE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Yellow
Green
Red
Blue
White
B
D
D
D
D
3SB3423-1QA
3SB3423-1QC
3SB3423-1QB
3SB3423-1QD
3SB3423-1QE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Yellow
Blue
Green
Red
White
D
B
B
B
B
3SB3423-1RA
3SB3423-1RD
3SB3423-1RC
3SB3423-1RB
3SB3423-1RE
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Black
Blue
Green/Yellow
B
B
B
3SB3423-2F
3SB3423-2G
3SB3423-2H
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
100 10 units
102
2
3
4
2,3
NSD0_00017
NSD00007
3SB34 23-0B
1)
3SB3423-0B
D
3-4
0 1
mm
4
1 NC
B
NSD0_00015
NSD00006
1 NO
1-2
0 1
mm
24 V AC/DC
X1
k
X2
k
+
2
3
4
1,6
NSD0_01292b
110 V AC
X1
k
k
+
X2
NSD0_01296b
230 V AC
X1
k
k
+
X2
NSD0_01296b
10
Fixpoint terminals
3SB34 23-2G
1)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
Version
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
Accessories
Pressure plates for selector switches and key-operated switches B
For actuating the central contact block of 3 contact blocks
3SB3901-0AW
3SB39 01-0AW
10/92
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
Inscription labels for enclosures
■ Overview
Black labels
The inscription labels (black with white inscription or silver-colored with black print) have an adhesive layer on the back. The
size of the labels is 22 mm × 22 mm.
Inscriptions
The inscriptions have upper case initial letters. The typeface is
Arial. Graphic symbols, including those not listed in the catalog,
are according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see page 10/94).
■ Selection and ordering data
PU (UNIT) = 1
PS*
= 10 units (customized inscription: 1 unit)
PG
= 102
Inscriptions
DT Black
Order No.
DT Silver-colored
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Inscription labels, self-adhesive, 22 mm × 22 mm
For self-inscription
}
3SB3906-1AA
B
3SB1901-3AA
Ein
On
Aus
Off
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1AB
3SB3906-1EB
3SB3906-1AC
3SB3906-1EC
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-3AB
3SB1901-3EB
3SB1901-3AC
3SB1901-3EC
Auf
Up
Ab
Down
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1AD
3SB3906-1ED
3SB3906-1AE
3SB3906-1EE
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-3AD
3SB1901-3ED
3SB1901-3AE
3SB1901-3EE
Auf
Open
Zu
Close
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1AD
3SB3906-1EP
3SB3906-1AL
3SB3906-1EQ
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-3AD
3SB1901-3EP
3SB1901-3AL
3SB1901-3EQ
Vor
Forward
Zurück
Reverse
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1AF
3SB3906-1EF
3SB3906-1AG
3SB3906-1EG
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-3AF
3SB1901-3EF
3SB1901-3AG
3SB1901-3EG
Rechts
Right
Links
Left
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1AH
3SB3906-1EH
3SB3906-1AJ
3SB3906-1EJ
B
3SB1901-3AH
-3SB1901-3AJ
--
Schnell
Fast
Langsam
Slow
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1AM
3SB3906-1ER
3SB3906-1AN
3SB3906-1ES
B
Betrieb
Running
Störung
Fault
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1AP
3SB3906-1EV
3SB3906-1AQ
3SB3906-1EW
B
B
B
3SB1901-3AP
3SB1901-3EV
3SB1901-3AQ
--
Einrichten
Start
Reset
Test
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1AR
3SB3906-1EL
3SB3906-1EM
3SB3906-1EN
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-3AR
3SB1901-3EL
3SB101-3EM
3SB19 01-3EN
Halt
Stop
NOT-HALT
NOT-AUS
EMERGENCY STOP
B
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1AK
3SB3906-1EK
3SB3906-1AS
3SB3906-1AV
3SB3906-1EY
B
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-3AK
3SB1901-3EK
3SB1901-3AT
3SB1901-3AS
3SB1901-3EY
Fans
Pump
Cooling
Heizung
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1CA
3SB3906-1CB
3SB3906-1CC
3SB3906-1CD
B
-3SB1901-3CB
---
Lighting
Filter
Motor
Compressor
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1CE
3SB3906-1CF
3SB3906-1CG
3SB3906-1CH
B
X
3SB1901-3CE
--3SB1901-3CH
O
I
II
III
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1MB
3SB3906-1MC
3SB3906-1MD
3SB3906-1ME
B
B
B
B
3SB1901-3MB
3SB1901-3MC
3SB1901-3MD
3SB1901-3ME
O I (horizontal)
I O II (horizontal)
I O (vertical)
II O I (vertical)
B
B
B
B
3SB3906-1MF
3SB3906-1MG
3SB3906-1MH
3SB3906-1MW
B
B
B
C
3SB1901-3MF
3SB1901-3MG
3SB1901-3MH
3SB1901-3MW
→
B
3SB3906-1NA
B
3SB1901-3NA
Blank
With inscription
B
3SB1901-3AM
-3SB1901-3AN
--
10
B
With graphic symbol
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/93
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
Inscription labels for enclosures
Inscriptions
DT Black
Order No.
DT Silver-colored
Price
per PU
Order No.
Price
per PU
Inscription labels, self-adhesive, 22 mm × 22 mm
With customized inscription
3SB3906-0XZ
For inscriptions or symbols see "Options"
3SB1901-3XZ
• Text line(s)
C
K0Y
C
K0Y
• Text line(s) or symbol with No.
B
K1Y, K2Y,
K3Y or K5Y
D
K1Y, K2Y,
K3Y or K5Y
• Any inscription or symbol
B
K9Y
D
K9Y
■ Options
Customized inscriptions
Ordering notes
The labels can be inscribed with text and symbols not listed in
the ordering data.
Append the following codes to the Order No.:
• Text line in upper/lower case, always upper case for beginning
of line (e.g. "Lift off"): K0Y
• Text line(s) in upper case (e.g. "LIFT OFF"): K1Y
• Text line(s) in lower case (e.g. "lift off"): K2Y
• Text line(s) in upper/lower case, all words begin with upper
case letters (e.g. "Lift Off"): K5Y
• Symbol with number according to ISO 7000 or IEC 60417:
K3Y
• Any inscription or symbol according to order form supplement: K9Y
A letter height of 4 mm is used as standard for text inscriptions
(1 to 3 lines)
Up to 11 characters per line are possible. The typeface used is
Arial. Other letter heights and typefaces are possible, but must
be specified when ordering.
Examples for customized inscription
When ordering, specify the required inscription in plain text in
addition to the order number and order code. In the case of special inscriptions with words in languages other than German,
give the exact spelling and specify the language.
Two-line inscription in upper/lower case lettering (K0Y)
In the case of multi-line inscriptions, the text must be assigned
to the respective line, e.g. "Z1 = Lift, Z2 =Lower". For long words
you can also specify the end-of-line division (see ordering
example 1).
10
Symbols can also be ordered with numbers according to
ISO 7000 or IEC 60417 (see ordering example 2 and 3).
Single-line inscription in upper case lettering (K1Y)
For special symbols (order code K9Y), a CAD drawing in DXF
format can be submitted.
Ordering example 1
A label with 2 lines of text is required:
3SB39 06–0XZ
K1Y
Z1 = LIFT
Z2 = LOWER
Three-line inscription in lower case letters (K2Y)
Ordering example 2
A label inscribed with symbol No. 5011 according to IEC 60417
is required:
3SB39 06–0XZ
K3Y
Z = 5011 IEC
Ordering example 3
Symbol number 5011 according to IEC 60417 (K3Y)
A label inscribed with symbol No. 1118 according to ISO 7000 is
required:
3SB39 06–0XZ
K3Y
Z = 1118 ISO
Any symbol according to order form supplement (K9Y)
10/94
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures
Accessories for enclosures
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Color/
inscription
DT Order No.
Blanking plugs
For plastic version, round
Black
}
Blanking plugs (plastic)
For metal version, round
Aluminized
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SB3921-0AA
1 10 units
102
B
3SB1902-0AQ
1 10 units
102
Holders for pushbuttons and
switches1)
For snapping on 3 blocks,
for front plate mounting
}
3SB3901-0AB
100 20 units
102
Holders for selector switches and keyoperated switches with pressure plate
For actuating a central contact block, for
front plate mounting
}
3SB3901-0AC
100 10 units
102
Pressure plates for selector switches
and key-operated switches
For actuating a central contact block, for
floor mounting
B
3SB3901-0AW
100 10 units
102
D
3SB1902-1AQ
1
1 unit
102
Blanking plugs for spare command points
3SB39 21-0AA
3SB19 02-0AQ
Holders and pressure plates
3SB39 01-0AB
3SB39 01-0AC
3SB39 01-0AW
Yellow name plates
Without inscription
As backing plate for EMERGENCY-STOP, With inscription
self-adhesive
• NOT-HALT
B
3SB1902-2AQ
1
1 unit
102
• NOT-AUS
B
3SB3921-0CJ
1
1 unit
102
With recess for
inscription label
B
3SB3921-0BV
1
1 unit
102
M20 cable glands
Incl. hexagonal nut
B
3SB3901-0CK
1
1 unit
102
M25 cable glands
incl. hexagonal nut
B
3SB3901-0CM
1
1 unit
102
M20 hexagonal nuts
For cable glands
B
3SB3901-0CL
100 10 units
102
M25 hexagonal nuts
For cable glands
B
3SB3901-0CN
100 10 units
102
3SB39 01-0CK
3SB39 01-0CL
Connecting pieces
For connecting 2 plastic enclosures
3SB39 01-0C
• M20/M20
B
3SB3901-0CS
1
1 unit
102
• M20/M25
B
3SB3901-0CT
1
1 unit
102
• M25/M25
B
3SB3901-0CU
1
1 unit
102
Connecting pieces
For connecting 2 metal enclosures
• M20/M20
B
3SB3901-0CP
1
1 unit
102
• M20/M25
B
3SB3901-0CQ
1
1 unit
102
Enclosure nuts
For plastic version
B
3SB3931-0AB
1 10 units
102
3SB39 01-0C
3SB39 01-0AB
1)
The holder for illuminated commanding devices is included in the scope of
supply.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/95
10
Accessories for enclosures
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures for AS-Interface
General data
■ Overview
Installation of AS-Interface slaves
The following slave types are available for connecting the
command points:
• Slave in A/B technology with 4 inputs and 3 outputs
• Slave with 4 inputs and 4 outputs
• F slave with 2 safe inputs for EMERGENCY-STOP
The following table shows the maximum number of equippable
slaves:
AS-Interface enclosure with customized equipment
Distributed command devices of the 3SB3 series can be quickly connected to the AS-Interface using AS-Interface enclosures. Using suitable
components you can make your own enclosures with integrated
AS-Interface or flexibly modify existing enclosures.
Enclosures for
Number of slaves
for enclosures
without EMERGENCYSTOP
Number of slaves
for enclosures
with EMERGENCY-STOP
1 command point
Not available
1 x F slave
2 command points 1 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O
Not available
3 command points 1 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O
1 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O +
1 x F slave
4 command points 2 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O1)
2 × slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O +
1 × F slave1)
6 command points 2 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O
2 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O +
1 x F slave
1)
For metal enclosures with 4 command points, only 1 x slave 4I/4O or 4I/3O
is possible.
Connection
One set of links is required in each case to connect a slave to
contact blocks, to lampholders and to the connection element.
NSD0_01414
10
The connection elements are mounted in the front-end cable
glands and are used for connection of the AS-Interface or for
bringing unused inputs or outputs out of the enclosure.
EMERGENCY-STOP enclosure
Enclosures
Color of enclosure cover:
• Gray, RAL 7035, or
• Yellow, RAL 1004, for EMERGENCY-STOP.
Color of enclosure base:
• Black, RAL 9005
For connection to the AS-Interface bus there is a choice of the
following options:
• Terminal for shaped AS-Interface cable. The cable is contacted by the insulation piercing method and routed past the
enclosure on the outside (possible only with plastic
enclosure).
• Cable gland for the shaped AS-Interface cable or round
cable. The cable is routed into the enclosure (preferable for
metal enclosure).
• Connection using M12 plug.
If less than all inputs/outputs of the installed slaves in an enclosure are used for connecting the command devices, free inputs
and outputs can be routed on request to the outside through an
M12 socket on the top or bottom side of the enclosure.
To supply inputs with power, the S+ connection of the must be
assigned to the socket, for outputs the OUT– connection must
be assigned.
Addressing is performed using the AS-Interface connections or
the integrated addressing socket. An external power supply is
not required.
Customized enclosures (selection by configurator)
To order customized 3SF58 AS-Interface enclosures with the
3SB3 control devices, use the 3SB/3SF configurator to select the
blocks for equipping. An electronic order form will be generated
for the additional options.
For ordering notes see page 10/90.
10/96
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures for AS-Interface
AS-Interface enclosures with standard fittings
■ Overview
Enclosures with standard fittings are available with:
• 1 to 3 command points
• Operational voltage through AS-Interface (approx. 30 V)
• Vertical mounting type
• Plastic enclosures are equipped with plastic actuators and indicators, metal enclosures are equipped with metal actuators
and indicators.
EMERGENCY-STOP enclosures are fitted with two NC contact
blocks, which are wired to the safe slave. The contact blocks
and lampholders (with spring-type terminals) of the control device, and the AS-Interface slaves, are mounted in the base of the
enclosure and are cable-connected.
The plastic versions of the enclosures have a connection for the
AS-Interface flat cable (the cable is routed past the enclosure on
the outside); in the case of the metal versions the AS-Interface
cable is routed into the enclosure.
The actuators/indicators are fixed with an enclosure nut. If required it can be disassembled with a 27 mm socket wrench or
with a 3SX17 07 ring nut wrench.
The EMERGENCY-STOP enclosures can also be supplied with
an M12 connector in place of the gland.
The enclosures without EMERGENCY-STOP each have one user
module with 4I/3O; the enclosures with EMERGENCY-STOP
have a safe AS-Interface slave integrated in the enclosure.
■ Selection and ordering data
Equipping options
(A, B, C = identification letters of the command points)
No. of command points
DT Order No.
Price PU (UNIT,
per PU
SET, M)
PS*
PG
B 3SF5811-0AA10
1
1 unit
121
AS-Interface enclosures, plastic
With M12 top connector
A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons,
with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism, 1 NC, 1 NC,
yellow enclosure top
1
With terminal for insulation piercing method at top
3SF5 812-0DA00
• Yellow enclosure top
• Yellow enclosure top, with protective collar
1
1
A 3SF5811-0AA08
A 3SF5811-0AB08
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
121
121
B = Pushbutton green, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO
2
A 3SF5812-0DA00
1
1 unit
121
B = Pushbutton white, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton black, label "O", 1 NO
2
A 3SF5812-0DB00
1
1 unit
121
C = Indicator lights clear,
label without inscription
B = Pushbutton green, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO
3
A 3SF5813-0DA00
1
1 unit
121
C = Indicator lights clear,
label without inscription
B = Pushbutton white, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton black, label "O", 1 NO
3
A 3SF5813-0DC00
1
1 unit
121
C = Pushbutton black, label "II", 1 NO
B = Pushbutton black, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO
3
A 3SF5813-0DB00
1
1 unit
121
1
1
C 3SF5811-2AA10
C 3SF5811-2AB10
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
121
121
• Yellow enclosure top
• Yellow enclosure top, with protective collar
1
1
A 3SF5811-2AA08
A 3SF5811-2AB08
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
121
121
B = Pushbutton green, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO
2
A 3SF5812-2DA00
1
1 unit
121
B = Pushbutton white, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton black, label "O", 1 NO
2
A 3SF5812-2DB00
1
1 unit
121
C = Indicator lights clear,
label without inscription
B = Pushbutton green, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO
3
A 3SF5813-2DA00
1
1 unit
121
C = Indicator lights clear,
label without inscription
B = Pushbutton white, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton black, label "O", 1 NO
3
A 3SF5813-2DC00
1
1 unit
121
C = Pushbutton black, label "II", 1 NO
B = Pushbutton black, label "I", 1 NO
A = Pushbutton red, label "O", 1 NO
3
A 3SF5813-2DB00
1
1 unit
121
AS-Interface enclosures, metal
With M12 top connector
A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons,
with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism, 1 NC, 1 NC
• Yellow enclosure top
• Yellow enclosure top, with protective collar
With cable gland at top
3SF5 811-2AB08
3SF5 813-2DA00
A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons,
with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism, 1 NC, 1 NC
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/97
10
3SF5 811-0AA08
A = EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbuttons,
with rotate-to-unlatch mechanism, 1 NC, 1 NC
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Pushbuttons and Indicator Lights, 22 mm
Enclosures for AS-Interface
Components for AS-Interface enclosures
■ Selection and ordering data
For self-equipping of the enclosures
Version
Number of
command
points
DT Order No.
F slave, 2 safe inputs,
for plastic enclosure,
EMERGENCY-STOP, without protective collar
1 ... 6
A
F slave, 2 safe inputs,
for plastic or metal enclosure,
EMERGENCY-STOP, with protective collar
1
A/B slave, 4I/3O
for plastic enclosure
Slave, 4I/4O,
for plastic enclosure
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
3SF5500-0BA
1
1 unit
121
A
3SF5500-0DA
1
1 unit
121
2 ... 6
A
3SF5500-0BB
1
1 unit
121
2 ... 6
A
3SF5500-0BC
1
1 unit
121
For F slave
A
3SF5900-0BA
1
1 unit
121
For slave 4I/4O or A/B slave 4I(3O)
A
3SF5900-0BB
1
1 unit
121
For plastic enclosures
AS-Interface slaves
3SF5 500-0BA
3SF5 500-0BB
Sets of links
3SF5 900-0CA
3SF5 900-0CC
3SF5 900-0CG
Connection elements
For AS-Interface shaped cable,
connection by insulation piercing method,
for plastic enclosure
1 ... 3
A
3SF5900-0CA
1
1 unit
121
4 ... 6
B
3SF5900-0CB
1
1 unit
121
For AS-Interface
connection using M12 plug,
for plastic enclosure
1 ... 3
B
3SF5900-0CC
1
1 unit
121
4 ... 6
B
3SF5900-0CD
1
1 unit
121
For bringing out unused inputs/outputs through an M12 1 ... 3
socket, for plastic enclosure
4 ... 6
For AS-Interface shaped cable,
1 ... 3
cable is routed into the enclosure,
4 ... 6
for plastic or metal enclosure
B
3SF5900-0CE
1
1 unit
121
B
3SF5900-0CF
1
1 unit
121
A
3SF5900-0CG
1
1 unit
121
A
3SF5900-0CH
1
1 unit
121
For round cable,
cable is routed into the enclosure,
for plastic or metal enclosure
1 ... 3
A
3SF5900-0CJ
1
1 unit
121
4 ... 6
A
3SF5900-0CK
1
1 unit
121
F slave, 2 safe inputs,
for metal enclosure,
EMERGENCY-STOP, without protective collar
1 ... 6
A
3SF5500-0CA
1
1 unit
121
F slave, 2 safe inputs,
for plastic or metal enclosure,
EMERGENCY-STOP, with protective collar
1
A
3SF5500-0DA
1
1 unit
121
For metal enclosures
10
AS-Interface slaves
3SF5 500-0CB
A/B slave, 4I/3O, for metal enclosure
2 ... 6
A
3SF5500-0CB
1
1 unit
121
Slave, 4I/4O, for metal enclosure
2 ... 6
A
3SF5500-0CC
1
1 unit
121
For F slave
A
3SF5900-0BA
1
1 unit
121
For slave 4I/4O or A/B slave 4I(3O)
A
3SF5900-0BB
1
1 unit
121
1 ... 3
B
3SF5900-2CC
1
1 unit
121
4 ... 6
B
3SF5900-2CD
1
1 unit
121
For bringing out unused inputs/outputs through an M12 1 ... 3
socket, for metal enclosure
4 ... 6
For AS-Interface shaped cable,
1 ... 3
cable is routed into the enclosure,
4 ... 6
for plastic or metal enclosure
B
3SF5900-2CE
1
1 unit
121
B
3SF5900-2CF
1
1 unit
121
A
3SF5900-0CG
1
1 unit
121
A
3SF5900-0CH
1
1 unit
121
For round cable,
cable is routed into the enclosure,
for plastic or metal enclosure
1 ... 3
A
3SF5900-0CJ
1
1 unit
121
4 ... 6
A
3SF5900-0CK
1
1 unit
121
Sets of links
Connection elements
3SF5 900-0CG
3SF5 900-0CJ
10/98
For AS-Interface
connection using M12 plug, for metal enclosure
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SB3 Two-Hand Operation Consoles
Plastic and metal enclosures
The standard equipment comprises:
• 2 black mushroom pushbuttons, Ø 40 mm, 1 NO + 1 NC,
Order No. 3SB30 00-1GA11 or 3SB35 00-1GA11
• 1 red EMERGENCY-STOP mushroom pushbutton according
to ISO 13850, Ø 40 mm, with positive latching, 2 NC,
Order No. 3SB30 00-1HA20 or 3SB35 00-1HA20.
■ Overview
The plastic version can be retrofitted with up to 8 customized
command points. The surface of the console has premachined
breaking points for this purpose.
■ Application
The two-hand operation consoles are required for use with machines and systems that have hazardous areas, in order to direct
both hands of the operator to one position.
Operator panels are primarily used on presses, stamping machines, printing presses and paper converting machines, in the
chemical industry and in the rubber and plastics industries.
Two-hand operation console with metal enclosure
Equipment
The two-hand operation consoles are pre-equipped with 3SB3
command devices. In the case of plastic enclosures the command points are equipped as standard with actuators and indicators made of plastic, in the case of metal enclosures they are
equipped with actuators and indicators made of metal.
The control command is given by pressing the two mushroom
pushbuttons on the sides simultaneously (within 0.5 s of each
other) and must be maintained for as long as a hazard exists.
For the further processing of control commands, suitable evaluation units are used, e.g. 3TK28 3 safety relays (see Safety
Relays in chapter 7).
Standards
The two-hand operation consoles comply with the requirements
of EN 574.
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Metal enclosures, degree of protection IP65
• With standard fittings
B
3SB3863-4BB
1
1 unit
102
• With standard fittings and 4 additional holes for
22.5 mm command devices1)
B
3SB3863-4BA
1
1 unit
102
• Empty enclosure, unequipped
B
3SB3863-4BC
1
1 unit
102
Two-hand operation consoles, plastic enclosure
B
With standard fittings and premachined breaking points
for 8 additional 22.5 mm1) command devices,
with holes for metric cable glands
3SB3863-1BB3
1
1 unit
102
Stands for two-hand operation consoles
With holes for metric cable glands
3SB3901-0AQ3
1
1 unit
102
3SB38 63-4BB
Plastic enclosures, degree of protection IP65
3SB38 63-1BB3
Accessories
B
3SB39 01-0AQ
1)
See 3SB3 pushbuttons and indicator lights.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/99
10
Two-hand operation consoles, metal enclosure
© Siemens AG 2010
3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches
3SE7 metal enclosures
Contact blocks
■ Overview
The switches for wire lengths up to 50 m are supplied with
1 NO + 1 NC or 2 NC contacts and those up to 75 m with
1 NO + 3 NC contacts. The switches for wire lengths from
2 × 75 m and the conveyor belt unbalance protection device are
supplied with 2 NO + 2 NC contacts.
The NC contacts of the cable-break or cable-pull signaling are
positive opening. The NO contact can be used, for example, for
signaling purposes.
Free position and indication
Cable-operated switches with one-side operation are held in
free position by the pre-tension on the turnbuckle.
On switches with interlocking, with a pretensioned cable, the
locking must be deactivated beforehand in order to return the
cable-operated switch to its original position.
The cable-operated switch and the conveyor belt unbalance
tracker can be supplied optionally with a factory-fitted LED (red,
24 V DC). This light in innovative chip-on-board technology allows the operating state of the switch to be visible at a distance
of at least 50 m.
Cable-operated switches
The cable-operated switches are used for monitoring or for
EMERGENCY-STOP devices on particularly endangered system
sections.
■ Application
As the effective range of a cable-operated switch is only limited
by the length of the trip-wire, large systems can also be protected. Cable-operated switches (requiring pulling at both ends)
and conveyor belt unbalance trackers are used primarily for
monitoring very long belt systems.
Standards
The switches are equipped with positive latching and positive
NC contacts and are thus suitable for operation in EMERGENCYSTOP devices according to EN ISO 13850.
■ Technical specifications
Type
3SE7 120
3SE7 150
3SE7 140
3SE7 141
3SE7 160
3SE7 310
10
General data
Standards
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1;
IEC 60204-1, EN 60204-1; EN ISO 13850
Approvals
UL/CSA
Electrical design
Contacts electrically isolated from each other
Electrical load
• 2-pole, at AC-15
400 V AC, 6 A
400 V AC, 6 A
250 V AC, 2 A
400 V AC, 6 A
--
• 3-pole, at AC-15
250 V AC, 2 A
--
--
--
--
• 4-pole, at AC-15
--
--
--
400 V AC, 6 A
400 V AC, 6 A
• Min.
24 V AC/DC, 10 mA
75
2 × 75
–
Short-circuit protection
A
6 (slow)
Mechanical endurance
> 1 million operating cycles
Contact material
Fine silver
Operation
By pulling or breaking of wire
Wire length, maximum
m
10
25
50
Distance between wire supports, max.
m
2.5
3
5
–
Enclosures
Enclosure material
GD Al alloy, coated (color), dark black RAL 9005
Cover
Shock-resistant thermoplast
Degree of protection acc. to EN 60529
Ambient temperature
IP65
°C
Mounting
IP65
3 × (M20 × 1.5)
2 × (M25 × 1.5)
Designed for M5
Fixing spacing
mm
30 and 40
Cable entry
2 × (M20 × 1.5)
Connection type
Screw terminals M3.5, self-lifting clamp terminal
10/100
IP67
–25 ... +70
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
1 × (M16 × 1.5)
© Siemens AG 2010
3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches
3SE7 metal enclosures
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Wire
length
Contacts
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
m
Cable-operated switches
Metal enclosures, IP65
(cover made of molded plastic)
10
• Without latching, only cable pull
monitoring
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
A
3SE7120-2DD01
1
1 unit
102
• With latching and button reset
2 NC
1)
A
3SE7120-1BF00
1
1 unit
102
1 NO + 2 NC
1)
A
3SE7120-1BH00
1
1 unit
102
• Without latching
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
A
3SE7150-2DD00
1
1 unit
102
• With latching and button reset
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
A
3SE7150-1BD00
1
1 unit
102
2 NC
1)
A
3SE7150-1BF00
1
1 unit
102
1 NO + 2 NC
1)
B
3SE7150-1BH00
1
1 unit
102
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SE7150-1CD00
1
1 unit
102
• Without latching
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SE7150-2DD04
1
1 unit
102
• With latching and button reset
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SE7150-1BD04
1
1 unit
102
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
A
3SE7140-1BD00
1
1 unit
102
2 NC
1)
B
3SE7140-1BF00
1
1 unit
102
• In addition with LED, red, 24 V DC
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SE7140-1BD04
1
1 unit
102
• With latching and key unlatching
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SE7140-1CD00
1
1 unit
102
1 NO + 3 NC
1)
A
3SE7141-1EG10
1
1 unit
102
- With yellow lid
3SE7 120-1BH00
Metal enclosures, IP65
(cover made of molded plastic),
with dust protection and alignment
window
25
- With yellow lid
• With latching and key unlatching
3SE7 150-1BD00
3SE7 150-1BH00
Metal enclosures, IP65
(cover made of molded plastic),
with dust protection and alignment
window,
with LED, red, 24 V DC
25
3SE7 150-1BD04
50
• With latching and button reset
3SE7 140-1B.00
Metal enclosures, IP67
(cover made of molded plastic),
with EMERGENCY-STOP
mushroom,
rotate-to-unlatch mechanism
75
Metal enclosures, IP65
With actuation on both sides
2 × 75
3SE7 141-1EG10
• With latching and button reset
• In addition with LED, red, 24 V DC
2 NO + 2 NC
1)
A
3SE7160-1AE00
1
1 unit
102
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SE7160-1BD00
1
1 unit
102
2 NO + 2 NC
1)
B
3SE7160-1AE04
1
1 unit
102
3SE7 160-1AE00
1)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/101
10
Metal enclosures, IP65
(cover made of molded plastic),
with dust protection
© Siemens AG 2010
3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches
3SE7 metal enclosures
Version
Wire
length
Contacts
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
m
Conveyor belt unbalance trackers
Metal enclosures, IP65
• With latching and button reset
2 NO + 2 NC
1)
B
3SE7310-1AE00
1
1 unit
102
• In addition with LED, red, 24 V DC
2 NO + 2 NC
1)
B
3SE7310-1AE04
1
1 unit
102
3SE7 310-1AE00
1)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
■ Accessories
Configuration of the cable-operated switches
Short lengths of wire up to 25 m
Wire clamp,
simplex,
oval,
Ø4 mm
3SE7 941-1AC
Wire clamp,
simplex,
oval,
Ø4 mm
3SE7 941-1AC
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AC
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AC
Wire,
Wire clamp,
simplex,
Ø4 mm
oval,
3SE7 910
Ø4 mm
3SE7 941-1AC
Turnbuckle
M6 x 60
3SE7 950-1AB
Eyebolt
M8
3SE7 920-1AB
Wire clamp,
simplex,
oval,
Ø4 mm
3SE7 941-1AC
Eyebolt
M8
3SE7 9201AB
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AC
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AC
NSC0_00288d
SIRIUS
cable-operated
switch
3SE7 120
3SE7 150
Wire clamp,
simplex,
oval,
Ø4 mm
3SE7 941-1AC
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AD
Wire clamp,
Wire clamp,
Turnbuckle
simplex,
simplex,
M6 x 60
oval,
oval,
3SE7 950-1AB
Ø4 mm
Ø4 mm
3SE7
3SE7 941-1AC
941-1AC
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AD
3SE7 930-1AD
Use of a tension spring is essential for lengths of wire
Wire,
Ø4 mm
3SE7 910
Wire clamp,
Tension spring
simplex,
35 N
oval,
3SE7 931-1AD
Ø4 mm
3SE7 941-1AC
Wire roller, rotatable
3SE7 921-1AC
Eyebolt
M10
3SE7 9201AC
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AD
25 m.
NSC0_00289f
SIRIUS
cable-operated
switch
3SE7 140
Pulling from both sides up to 2 x 75 m
Wire, Ø4 mm
3SE7 910
Tension spring
up to 2 x 50 m:
3SE7 931-1AD
up to 2 x 75 m:
3SE7 931-1AE
Eyebolt M10
3SE7 920-1AC
Wire
Wire clamp, Wire clamp,
Turnbuckle
simplex,oval, M6 x 60
clamp,
simplex,
Ø4 mm
oval,
3SE7 950-1AB simplex,
3SE7 941-1AC
oval, Ø4 mm
Ø4 mm
3SE7
3SE7 941941-1AC
1AC
Wire roller, rotatable
Wire roller, rotatable
3SE7 921-1AC
3SE7 921-1AC
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AD
SIGUARD
cable-operated
switch
3SE7 160
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AD
Wire
Wire
Tension spring
clamp,
clamp,
up to 2 x 50 m:
simplex,
simplex, 3SE7 931-1AD
oval,
oval,
up to 2 x 75 m:
Ø4 mm
Ø4 mm
3SE7 931-1AE
3SE7
3SE7
941-1AC
941-1AC
Wire rollers, rotatable
3SE7 921-1AC
Wire eye, Ø4 mm
3SE7 930-1AD
Use of a tension spring is essential for lengths of wire 25 m.
Note:
Large temperature fluctuations require corresponding compensation springs. For reliable connection the PVC sheath must be
10/102
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
NSC0_00499e
10
Long lengths of wire up to 50 m
removed from the clamping area of the steel bowden wire.
Bowden wire supports must be used at the recommended
intervals.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches
3SE7 metal enclosures
Version
Wire length/
diameter
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Trip-wires with fixing
Steel wires, with red plastic sheath,
Ø 4 mm1)
10 m
A
3SE7910-3AA
1
1 unit
102
15 m
A
3SE7910-3AB
1
1 unit
102
20 m
A
3SE7910-3AC
1
1 unit
102
50 m
A
3SE7910-3AH
1
1 unit
102
• Oval
2 × Ø 4 mm
A
3SE7941-1AC
1
1 unit
102
• Simplex (1 set = 4 units)
2 × Ø 4 mm
A
3SE7943-1AC
1
4 units
102
• Duplex (1 set = 4 units)
2 × Ø 4 mm
A
3SE7944-1AC
1
4 units
102
• Single (1 set = 4 units)
2 × Ø 4 mm
A
3SE7942-1AA
1
4 units
102
Wire clamps, galvanized white
• 13 N
A
3SE7931-1AB
1
1 unit
102
• 35 N, for bowden wires up to 50 m
A
3SE7931-1AD
1
1 unit
102
• > 35 N, for bowden wires up to 2 × 75 m
B
3SE7931-1AE
1
1 unit
102
A
3SE7921-1AC
1
1 unit
102
A
3SE7921-1AA
1
1 unit
102
A
3SE7930-1AD
1
4 units
102
• Including M8 nut
A
3SE7920-1AB
1
1 unit
102
• Including M10 nut
A
3SE7920-1AC
1
1 unit
102
Wire rollers for changing the direction of the
wire, rotatable
Ø 4 mm
Fixtures for the wire rollers
(incl. fixing nuts)
Wire eyes for changes in wire direction and
improved power transmission at the fixing
points (1 set = 4 units)
Ø 4 mm
Eyebolts for fixing the wire
Turnbuckles for precise adjustment of the pretension
• M6 x 60
A
3SE7950-1AB
1
1 unit
102
• M6 x 110
A
3SE7950-1AD
1
1 unit
102
LED lamps, red
24 V DC
25 mm diameter;
for M20 x 1.5 connection
C
3SX3235
1
1 unit
102
Spare parts
1)
Diameter including casing; the diameter of the steel wire is 3.2 mm.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/103
10
Tension springs (zinc-plated)
to maintain the counter tension
© Siemens AG 2010
3SE7, 3SF2 Cable-Operated Switches
3SF2 cable-operated switches for AS-Interface
AS-Interface cable-operated switches can now be directly
connected via the standard AS-Interface with safety-oriented
communication.
■ Overview
The safety functions no longer have to be conventionally wired
up.
■ Application
SIRIUS cable-operated switches are used for monitoring or for
EMERGENCY-STOP devices on particularly endangered system
sections.
As the effective range of a cable-operated switch is only limited
by the length of the trip-wire, large systems can also be
protected.
Standards
The switches with positive latching are suitable for operation in
EMERGENCY-STOP devices in according to ISO 13850. They
can achieve up to category 4 according to EN ISO 13849-1
(EN 954-1) or SIL 3 according to IEC 61508.
Cable-operated switch with AS-Interface adapter
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Basic switches
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET,
M)
PS*
PG
ASIsafe cable-operated switches
Metal enclosures, IP65
(cover made of molded plastic), with dust protection,
latching acc. to ISO 13850,
with button reset,
2 NC contacts
3SE7 120-1BF00
C
3SF2120-1BF00-0BA1
1
1 unit
121
• For wire lengths up to 25 m,
with alignment window
3SE7 150-1BF00
C
3SF2150-1BF00-0BA1
1
1 unit
121
• For wire lengths up to 50 m
3SE7 140-1BF00
B
3SF2140-1BF00-0BA1
1
1 unit
121
10
• For wire lengths up to 10 m,
with alignment window
3SF2 120-1BF00-0BA1
3SF2 150-1BF00-0BA1
3SF2 140-1BF00-0BA1
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
10/104
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
3SE2, 3SE3 Foot Switches
Plastic and metal enclosures
■ Overview
The switches have two contact blocks, each with one NO contact and one NC contact. The NO contacts and NC contacts of
the two contact blocks are connected for easy connection of a
single-phase motor. The normal workflow is initiated by pressing
down the pedal as far as the pressure point so that the two NO
contacts close and the motor starts to run.
If in the event of danger the pedal is pressed beyond the resistance of the pressure point, the positively driven NC contacts will
open and the motor is stopped. At the same time the independent latching takes effect and holds the NC contacts in open position. This prevents the machine parts from continuing to run out
of control or from being restarted.
After the hazard is eliminated, the machine can only be restarted
after manually releasing the switch using a pushbutton on the
top of the enclosure. The contacts are then released again and
return to their initial position (the NO contacts are open and the
NC contacts are closed).
■ Technical specifications
Standard switches
The 3SE2 9 and 3SE3 9 foot switch range encompasses versions in a metal enclosure for rugged applications as well as versions with plastic enclosure for less harsh environments. The devices can be supplied with or without a cover and have fixing
holes for them to be screwed to the floor.
Depending on the particular application, the metal enclosures
can be ordered in latching or momentary-contact versions. The
momentary-contact pedal switch in the plastic enclosure has
one microswitch (changeover contact) per actuating pedal.
Safety foot switches
The 3SE2 924-3AA20 single-pedal safety foot switches are used
on machines and plants as OK switches when operation by
hand is not possible and the EMERGENCY-STOP function must
be available if a hazardous status arises. The switches are interlocked according to EN ISO 13850 and bear the CE mark in accordance with the machinery directive.
The safety foot switches are protected by a guard hood against
accidental operation.
Type
3SE29
3SE39
Metal and plastic enclosures
Standards
IEC 60947-5-1
Electrical load
• At AC-15, 400 V
A
16
–
6 A for
3SE2903-1….
• At 250 V AC
A
–
5
Short-circuit protection
A
16 (slow)
5 (slow)
A
6 (slow) for
3SE2903-1….
Mechanical endurance
> 106 operating cycles
Material
• Enclosures
Aluminum
casting
Impact-resistant
thermoplast,
self-extinguishing according to
UL 94 VO
• Cover
Thermoplast
–
• Guard hood
Aluminum
casting
Metal
Degree of protection
IP65
IP65
Ambient temperature
°C -25 ... +80
Connection
Cable entry,
metric
10
Foot switches with metal enclosures
-10 ... +75
Cable AWG20,
UL Style 2464,
length 3 m
Application example
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/105
© Siemens AG 2010
3SE2, 3SE3 Foot Switches
Plastic and metal enclosures
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Slow-action
contacts
for each pedal
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Metal enclosures, degree of protection IP65
Momentary-contact foot switches,
single pedal
M20 x 1.5 cable entry
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
A
3SE2902-0AB20
1
1 unit
102
2 NO + 2 NC
1)
A
3SE2903-1AB20
1
1 unit
102
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
A
3SE2902-0AA20
1
1 unit
102
2 NO + 2 NC
1)
A
3SE2903-1AA20
1
1 unit
102
• Without hood
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
C
3SE2912-2AB20
1
1 unit
102
• With hood
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
C
3SE2912-2AA20
1
1 unit
102
• Without hood
• With hood
3SE2 90.-.AA20
3SE2 91.-.AA20
Momentary-contact foot switches,
single pedal
M20 x 1.5 cable entry
Momentary-contact foot switches,
two pedals
M25 x 1.5 cable entry
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SE2932-0AB20
1
1 unit
102
2 NO + 2 NC
1)
B
3SE2932-1AB20
1
1 unit
102
1 NO + 1 NC
1)
B
3SE2932-0AA20
1
1 unit
102
2 NO + 2 NC
1)
B
3SE2932-1AA20
1
1 unit
102
Safety foot switches,
2 NO + 2 NC
single pedal, with hood,
M20 x 1.5 cable entry,
with interlock according to ISO 13850,
NO closes as momentary contact
type, NC opens with latching
1)
C
3SE2924-3AA20
1
1 unit
102
• Without hood
3SE2 932-.AB20
• With hood
3SE2 932-.AA20
10
3SE2 924-3AA20
Plastic enclosures, degree of protection IP65
Momentary-contact
pedal switches, 3 m cable
Microswitch
• Single pedal
3SE3 902-4CA20
- Without hood
1 CO contact
B
3SE3902-4CB20
1
1 unit
102
- With hood
1 CO contact
B
3SE3902-4CA20
1
1 unit
102
2 × 1 CO contact
B
3SE3934-5CB20
1
1 unit
102
• Two pedals, without hood
3SE3 934-5CB20
1)
Positive opening according to IEC 60947-5-1, Appendix K.
10/106
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD4 Signaling Columns
General data
■ Overview
The 8WD4 signaling columns are flexible in design and versatile
in use.
1
1
2
3
2
3
4
5
4
6
7
8
9
10
5
11
6
7
15
8
14
9
10
11
8
12
15
13
14
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
NSC0_00727b
13
10
12
NSC0_00726b
Acoustic element 8WD42 .0-0FA
Light element 8WD42
AS-Interface adapter element 8WD42 28-0BB
Connection element 8WD42 08-0AA
Bracket for wall mounting 8WD42 08-0CD
Adapter for single-hole mounting 8WD42 08-0EH
Foot for mounting with pipe 8WD42 08-0DE
Pipe 8WD42 08-0EF/8WD43 08-0E.
Foot for mounting with pipe 8WD43 08-0DB
Foot for mounting with pipe (> 400 mm) 8WD43 08-0DC
Adjustable-angle foot for mounting on pipes 8WD44 08-0DF
Socket 8WD43 08-0DD
Socket (magnetic fixing) 8WD43 08-0DE
Bracket for mounting with foot 8WD44 08-0CC
8WD42 signaling columns (width 50 mm) with up to 4 elements
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
16
Acoustic element 8WD44
Light element 8WD44
AS-Interface adapter element 8WD44 28-0BD/8WD44 28-0BE
Connection element for mounting on bracket,
base and floor 8WD44 08-0AB/8WD44 08-0AE
Connection element for mounting on pipe
8WD44 08-0AA/8WD44 08-0AD
Bracket for wall mounting 8WD43 08-0CA
Bracket for wall mounting (two-sided) 8WD43 08-0CB
Socket 8WD43 08-0DD
Bracket for base mounting 8WD44 08-0CD
Pipe 8WD42 08-0EF/8WD43 08-0E.
Foot with pipe 8WD43 08-0DA
Foot for mounting with pipe 8WD43 08-0DB
Foot for mounting with pipe (> 400 mm) 8WD43 08-0DC
Adjustable-angle foot for mounting on pipes 8WD44 08-0DF
Socket (magnetic fixing) 8WD43 08-0DE
Bracket for mounting with foot 8WD44 08-0CC
8WD44 signaling columns (width 70 mm) with up to 5 elements
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/107
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD4 Signaling Columns
General data
Two product series are available:
• 8WD42
- Thermoplast enclosure, diameter 50 mm
- Degree of protection IP54
- Up to 4 elements can be mounted between the connection
element and the cover
• 8WD44
- Thermoplast enclosure, diameter 70 mm
- Advanced design and significantly improved illumination
- Fast and flexible connection using spring-type terminals
- Integrated degree of protection IP65
- Up to 5 elements can be mounted between the connection
element and the cover
■ Application
8WD4 signaling columns are used in machines or in automatic
processes for monitoring complex procedures or as visual or
acoustic warning devices in emergency situations, e.g. for displaying individual assembly stages.
Communication capability
Connection to AS-Interface
The 8WD4 signaling columns can be directly connected to the
AS-Interface bus system through an adapter element that can
be integrated. Wiring outlay is reduced as the result. The twowire bus cable is fixed to the screw terminals in the connection
element. Up to three signaling elements can be mounted on it
using an adapter element.
A/B technology enables the connection of up to 62 slaves on one
AS-Interface system.
Connection
The signaling elements are wired up using the screw terminals
in the connection element, screw terminals on the 8WD42 and
screw or spring-type terminals on the 8WD44.
Cable outlet
The connecting cables can be guided either downwards or sideways through the cable gland using an adapter that can be
screwed under the foot. This makes wiring easier if there is no
access from below.
Connection to AS-Interface
10
Signaling columns, mounting examples
The illustrated examples are from the left:
• 8WD42: Cover (no No.), 4 light elements %, connection
element (, pipe ,, foot • 8WD44: Cover (no No.), acoustic element $,
2 light elements %, connection element ), foot with pipe /
• 8WD44: Cover (no No.), 4 light elements %,
AS-Interface adapter element &, connection element (,
bracket for wall mounting *
• 8WD44: Cover (no No.), 3 light elements %,
AS-Interface adapter element &, connection element ),
foot with pipe /
Note:
The cover is supplied with the connection element.
■ Benefits
• Choice of various light and acoustic elements with different
functions:
continuous light, blinklight, flashlight and rotating light; buzzer
and siren
• Light elements with particularly long-lasting LEDs
• Variety of colors: red, yellow, green, white or blue
• Optimized illumination through improved prism technology
with the 8WD44
• Acoustic elements can be adjusted in tone and volume
• Extremely resistant to shock and vibrations
• Easy connection and quick lamp change with secure bayonet
mechanism
• Communication capability through connection to AS-Interface
10/108
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
8WD42:
The two-wire bus cable is fixed to the screw terminals in the connection element. The adapter element must be the first module
to be positioned on the connection element. A maximum of 4 signaling elements can then be mounted on it.
The 8WD42 28-0BB adapter element is a standard slave.
8WD44:
The two-wire bus cable is fixed to the screw or spring-type terminals in the connection element. The adapter element must be
the first module to be positioned on the connection element. The
signaling elements can then be mounted on it.
The 8WD44 28-0BE adapter element is a standard slave. A maximum of 4 signaling elements can be mounted on it.
The 8WD44 28-0BD adapter element with A/B technology enables the connection of up to 62 slaves on one AS-Interface system. The addressing socket provides user-friendly parameterization of the AS-Interface elements. A maximum of 3 signaling
elements can be mounted on it.
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD4 Signaling Columns
General data
■ Technical specifications
Type
8WD42
8WD44
General data
Approvals
UL, CSA
Light and acoustic elements
Rated voltage, power consumption
Light elements with incandescent lamp
(AC values for 50/60 Hz)
(AC values for 50/60 Hz)
• Continuous light
12 V, 24 V, 115 V, 230 V AC/DC
12 V, 24 V, 115 V, 230 V AC/DC
• Blinklight
24 V AC/DC/125 mA;
115 V AC/20 mA; 230 V AC/15 mA
24 V AC/DC/125 mA;
115 V AC/20 mA; 230 V AC/15 mA
• Flashlights
--
24 V DC/125 mA;
115 V AC/20 mA; 230 V AC/35 mA
• Max. inrush current, blinklight/flashlight
--
500 mA
• Continuous light
24 V AC/DC/60 mA
24 V AC/DC/45 mA; 115 V AC/DC/25 mA;
230 V AC/25 mA
• Blinklight
--
24 V AC/DC/40 mA
• Rotating light
--
24 V AC/DC/70 mA
• Buzzer element
(tone: pulsating or continuous, 85 dB)
24 V AC/DC/25 mA; 115 V AC/DC/25 mA;
230 V AC/25 mA
24 V AC/DC/25 mA; 115 V AC/DC/25 mA;
230 V AC/25 mA
• Siren element
(8 tones + amplification can be set, 100 dB)
--
24 V AC/DC/80 mA;
115 V AC/30 mA; 230 V AC/16 mA
• Siren element (108 dB)
--
24 V DC/100 mA
GSM radio elements
--
24 V DC (controlled ±15%)/50 mA,
transient 450 mA
max. 5
–
7
2
4 × 106 flashes
4 × 106 flashes
IO code/ID code
8/F
8/E
Power supply
• Operational voltage
• Power consumption Imax
Through bus cable
18.5 V ... 31.6
50
Through bus cable
18.5 V ... 31.6
100
Protective measures
• Watchdog
• Short-circuit/overload protection
• Reverse polarity protection
• Induction protection
✓
External back-up fuse M 1.6 A
✓
Does not apply
✓
✓
✓
✓
Outputs
4 Relay outputs
3 solid-state outputs
• Load voltage
V
V
External auxiliary voltage
0 ... 30 DC
0 ... 230 AC
Through bus cable or external auxiliary voltage,
switch-selectable
• Current carrying capacity ∑ Imax
- With external auxiliary voltage
- Without external auxiliary voltage
A
A
1.5
--
0.3
0.2
Operating temperature
°C
–20 ... +50
–20 ... +50
Enclosure material
Thermoplast (polyamide), impact-resistant,
black
Thermoplast (polyamide), impact-resistant,
black
Light elements, GSM radio element
Thermoplast (polycarbonate)
Thermoplast (polycarbonate)
✓
✓
✓
✓
-✓
IP54
IP54
IP65 (seal premounted with every module)
IP65
–20 ... +50
–20 ... +50
Light elements with integrated LED
Acoustic elements
Power consumption
• Incandescent lamps, base BA 15d
• Flashlight, flash energy
W
Ws
Endurance
• Flashlights
V
mA
10
AS-Interface adapter elements
Enclosures
Mounting
• Horizontal (for floor mounting,
foot with 25 mm Ø pipe)
• Horizontal (single-hole mounting)
• Vertical with bracket
Degree of protection
• Light elements
• Acoustic elements, AS-i adapter elements
Operating temperature
°C
Connection
• Conductor cross-sections
• Tightening torque
M3 screw terminals
mm2 Max. 2.5
Nm max. 0.5
Spring-type terminals/M3 screw terminals
Max. 2.5
– / max. 0.5
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/109
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD4 Signaling Columns
8WD42 signaling columns, 50 mm diameter
■ Overview
Features:
• Thermoplast enclosure, diameter 50 mm
• Degree of protection IP54
• Up to 4 elements can be mounted
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Acoustic elements1)
Rated voltage
Color
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
A 8WD4220-0FA
1
1 unit
102
A 8WD4240-0FA
1
1 unit
102
A 8WD4250-0FA
1
1 unit
102
102
V
Buzzer elements 80 dB,
24 AC/DC
pulsating or continuous tone, adjust- 115 AC
able by means of a wire jumper
230 AC
Black
Light elements for incandescent lamps/LEDs, BA 15d bases2)
Continuous light elements
24 ... 230 AC/DC
Red
A 8WD4200-1AB
1
1 unit
Green
A 8WD4200-1AC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4200-1AD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4200-1AE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4200-1AF
1
1 unit
102
102
Light elements with integrated LED
Continuous light elements
Blinklight elements
24 AC/DC
24 AC/DC
10
115 AC
230 AC
Red
A 8WD4220-5AB
1
1 unit
Green
A 8WD4220-5AC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4220-5AD
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4220-5BB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4220-5BC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4220-5BD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4220-5BE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4220-5BF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4240-5BB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4240-5BC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4240-5BD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
D 8WD4240-5BE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
D 8WD4240-5BF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4250-5BB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4250-5BC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4250-5BD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4250-5BE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4250-5BF
1
1 unit
102
Black
A 8WD4228-0BB
1
1 unit
102
Black
A 8WD4208-0AA
1
1 unit
102
Adapter elements for AS-Interface
AS-Interface adapter elements
with external auxiliary voltage
For 4 signaling
elements 24 V DC
Connection elements3)
Connection elements with cover
For mounting on pipes, floors and angles
1)
The cover is included in the scope of supply of the acoustic elements and
fixed in place.
2)
The lamp is not included in the scope of supply. Please order separately.
3)
The connection element with cover is an essential part for assembling the
signaling columns.
10/110
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
Note:
For mounting and configuring help see the publication "Versatile,
robust, communication-capable: SIRIUS signaling columns and
integrated signal lamps", Order No. E20001-A670-P305.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD4 Signaling Columns
8WD42 signaling columns, 50 mm diameter
Version
Rated voltage
Color
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
V
Lamps
Incandescent lamps, 5 W
Base BA 15d
24 AC/DC
A 8WD4328-1XX
1 10 units
102
115 AC
A 8WD4348-1XX
1 10 units
102
230 AC
A 8WD4358-1XX
1 10 units
102
LEDs
Base BA 15d
24 AC/DC
Red
Green
Yellow
Clear
Blue
A
A
A
A
A
8WD4428-6XB
8WD4428-6XC
8WD4428-6XD
8WD4428-6XE
8WD4428-6XF
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
115 AC
Red
Green
Yellow
Clear
Blue
A
A
A
A
A
8WD4448-6XB
8WD4448-6XC
8WD4448-6XD
8WD4448-6XE
8WD4448-6XF
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
230 AC
Red
Green
Yellow
Clear
Blue
A
A
A
A
A
8WD4458-6XB
8WD4458-6XC
8WD4458-6XD
8WD4458-6XE
8WD4458-6XF
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
Plastic, for mounting
on pipes
A 8WD4308-0DB
1
1 unit
102
Metal, for pipe
lengths > 400 mm
A 8WD4308-0DC
1
1 unit
102
Plastic, for floor
mounting (without
pipe)
A 8WD4208-0DE
1
1 unit
102
8WD4408-0DF
1
1 unit
102
Feet, single
Adjustable-angle feet
Plastic, for mounting
For positioning in 7.5° increments1) on pipes,
incl. rubber seal
Pipes, single
Sockets for feet
X
Length 100 mm
A 8WD4208-0EF
1
1 unit
102
Length 150 mm
A 8WD4308-0EE
1
1 unit
102
Length 250 mm
A 8WD4308-0EA
1
1 unit
102
Length 400 mm
A 8WD4308-0EB
1
1 unit
102
Length 1000 mm
A 8WD4308-0ED
1
1 unit
102
Side cable outlet
A 8WD4308-0DD
1
1 unit
102
Side cable outlet,
with magnetic fixing2)
A 8WD4308-0DE
1
1 unit
102
A 8WD4408-0CC
1
1 unit
102
Brackets for mounting with foot
Brackets for wall mounting
(plastic)
Mounting without feet
and pipe
A 8WD4208-0CD
1
1 unit
102
Adapters for single-hole
mounting
Mounting without feet
and pipe,
with M18 thread and
fixing nut
A 8WD4208-0EH
1
1 unit
102
For labeling panels, see 8WD44, page 10/114.
1)
Markings for 30°, 45°, 60° and 90°.
2)
For horizontal mounting, only 1 element is recommended.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/111
10
Mounting
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD4 Signaling Columns
8WD44 signaling columns, 70 mm diameter
■ Overview
Features:
• Thermoplast enclosure, diameter 70 mm
• Advanced design and significantly improved illumination
• Fast and flexible connection using spring-type terminals
• Integrated degree of protection IP65
• Up to 5 elements can be mounted.
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Acoustic elements1)
Rated voltage
Color
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
A 8WD4420-0FA
1
1 unit
102
A 8WD4440-0FA
1
1 unit
102
A 8WD4450-0FA
1
1 unit
102
A 8WD4420-0EA2
1
1 unit
102
115 AC
A 8WD4440-0EA2
1
1 unit
102
230 AC
A 8WD4450-0EA2
1
1 unit
102
A 8WD4420-0EA
1
1 unit
102
Black
Siren elements,
multi-tone, 100 dB,
8 tones and volume are adjustable
Black
24 AC/DC
Siren elements 108 dB, IP40
24 DC
Continuous light elements
12 ... 230 AC/DC
Light elements for incandescent lamps/LEDs, BA 15d bases2)
24 AC/DC
115 AC
10
230 AC
Black
Red
A 8WD4400-1AB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4400-1AC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4400-1AD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4400-1AE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4400-1AF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4420-1BB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4420-1BC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4420-1BD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4420-1BE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4420-1BF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4440-1BB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4440-1BC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4440-1BD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4440-1BE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4440-1BF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4450-1BB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4450-1BC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4450-1BD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4450-1BE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4450-1BF
1
1 unit
102
Light elements with integrated flash lamps3)
Flashlight elements with integrated 24 DC
electronic flash
115 AC
230 AC
1)
The cover is included in the scope of supply of the acoustic elements and
fixed in place.
2)
The lamp is not included in the scope of supply. Please order separately.
3)
The lamp is included in the scope of supply.
10/112
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
Price
per PU
V
Buzzer elements 85 dB,
24 AC/DC
pulsating or continuous tone, adjust- 115 AC
able by means of a wire jumper
230 AC
Blinklight elements
DT Order No.
Red
A 8WD4420-0CB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4420-0CC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4420-0CD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4420-0CE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4420-0CF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4440-0CB
1
1 unit
102
Green
D 8WD4440-0CC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4440-0CD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
D 8WD4440-0CE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
D 8WD4440-0CF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4450-0CB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4450-0CC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4450-0CD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4450-0CE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4450-0CF
1
1 unit
102
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD4 Signaling Columns
8WD44 signaling columns, 70 mm diameter
Version
Rated voltage
Color
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
V
Light elements with integrated LED
Continuous light elements
24 AC/DC
115 AC
230 AC
Blinklight elements
Rotating light elements
24 AC/DC
24 AC/DC
Red
A 8WD4420-5AB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4420-5AC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4420-5AD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4420-5AE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4420-5AF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4440-5AB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4440-5AC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4440-5AD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4440-5AE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4440-5AF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4450-5AB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4450-5AC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4450-5AD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD4450-5AE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD4450-5AF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4420-5BB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4420-5BC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4420-5BD
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD4420-5DB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD4420-5DC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD4420-5DD
1
1 unit
102
Adapter elements for AS-Interface
AS-Interface adapter elements
For 3 signaling
elements 24 V DC
Black
A 8WD4428-0BD
1
1 unit
102
• Standard AS-Interface,
with external auxiliary voltage
For 4 signaling
elements 24 V DC
Black
A 8WD4428-0BE
1
1 unit
102
• For mounting on pipes
A 8WD4408-0AA
1
1 unit
102
• For mounting on bracket and floor
A 8WD4408-0AB
1
1 unit
102
• For mounting on pipes
A 8WD4408-0AD
1
1 unit
102
• For mounting on bracket and floor
A 8WD4408-0AE
1
1 unit
102
24 AC/DC
A 8WD4328-1XX
1 10 units
102
115 AC
A 8WD4348-1XX
1 10 units
102
230 AC
A 8WD4358-1XX
1 10 units
102
elements1)
Connection elements with cover
10
Connection
• A/B technology,
with/without external auxiliary
voltage, switchable
Black
Screw terminals
Spring-type terminals
Lamps
Incandescent lamps, 5 W
Base BA 15d
LEDs
Base BA 15d
1)
24 AC/DC
Red
Green
Yellow
Clear
Blue
A
A
A
A
A
8WD4428-6XB
8WD4428-6XC
8WD4428-6XD
8WD4428-6XE
8WD4428-6XF
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
115 AC
Red
Green
Yellow
Clear
Blue
A
A
A
A
A
8WD4448-6XB
8WD4448-6XC
8WD4448-6XD
8WD4448-6XE
8WD4448-6XF
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
230 AC
Red
Green
Yellow
Clear
Blue
A
A
A
A
A
8WD4458-6XB
8WD4458-6XC
8WD4458-6XD
8WD4458-6XE
8WD4458-6XF
1
1
1
1
1
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
1 unit
102
102
102
102
102
The connection element with cover is an essential part for assembling the
signaling columns.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/113
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD4 Signaling Columns
8WD44 signaling columns, 70 mm diameter
Version
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
A 8WD4308-0DA
1
1 unit
102
Mounting
Feet with pipe
Feet, single
Adjustable-angle feet
For positioning
in 7.5° increments1)
Pipes, single
Sockets for feet
Plastic, for mounting on pipes A 8WD4308-0DB
1
1 unit
102
Metal,
for pipe lengths > 400 mm
A 8WD4308-0DC
1
1 unit
102
Plastic, for mounting on
pipes,
incl. rubber seal
X
8WD4408-0DF
1
1 unit
102
Length 100 mm
A 8WD4208-0EF
1
1 unit
102
Length 150 mm
A 8WD4308-0EE
1
1 unit
102
Length 250 mm
A 8WD4308-0EA
1
1 unit
102
Length 400 mm
A 8WD4308-0EB
1
1 unit
102
Length 1000 mm
A 8WD4308-0ED
1
1 unit
102
Side cable outlet
(can also be used without
feet)
A 8WD4308-0DD
1
1 unit
102
Side cable outlet,
with magnetic fixing2)
A 8WD4308-0DE
1
1 unit
102
For single-sided mounting
A 8WD4308-0CA
1
1 unit
102
For double-sided mounting
A 8WD4308-0CB
1
1 unit
102
A 8WD4408-0CC
1
1 unit
102
10
Brackets for wall mounting
(mounting without feet and pipe)
Pipe length 100 mm
Brackets for mounting with foot
Brackets for base mounting
Mounting without feet and
pipe
A 8WD4408-0CD
1
1 unit
102
Adapters for mounting on pipes
according to NPT
Mounting on pipes, ∅ 25 mm,
with NPT 1/2" thread
A 8WD4308-0DF
1
1 unit
102
A 8WD4408-0FA
1
1 unit
102
Inscriptions
Labeling panels
With fixing accessories for mounting on pipe ∅ 25 mm
Inscription area/ step 50 mm x 140 mm
Suitable for standard labels, e.g.
• Zweckform 3425
• Herma 4457
1)
Markings for 30°, 45°, 60° and 90°.
2)
For horizontal mounting, only 1 element is recommended.
10/114
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
Note:
For mounting and configuring help see the publication "Versatile,
robust, communication-capable: SIRIUS signaling columns and
integrated signal lamps", Order No. E20001-A670-P305.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD5 Integrated Signal Lamps
8WD53 integrated signal lamps, 70 mm diameter
■ Overview
Design
Features:
• Thermoplast enclosures, diameter 70 mm
• Degree of protection IP65
• Rated voltage 24 V, 115 V, 230 V AC/DC
• Ambient temperature -20 to +50 °C, incandescent lamp up to
60 °C
The special shape of the integrated signal lamps means that the
light is emitted optimally in every direction (to the sides and upwards). Continuous lights (with incandescent lamp or LED) and
single-flash lights are available in five colors.
The LED versions of the integrated signal lamps offer a considerably longer endurance than the incandescent lamp versions.
All integrated signal lamps have a high degree of protection IP65
and are made of a material highly resistant to impact.
Mounting
Integrated signal lamps
8WD53 integrated signal lamps can be mounted directly at any
point of the machine for the purpose of giving visual signals.
They are mounted by means of a Pg 29 screw base with nut.
■ Selection and ordering data
Version
Rated voltage
Color
DT Order No.
Price
per PU
PU
(UNIT,
SET, M)
PS*
PG
Lights for incandescent lamps/LED, BA 15d base
Continuous lights1)
24 ... 230 AC/DC
Red
A 8WD5300-1AB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD5300-1AC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD5300-1AD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD5300-1AE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD5300-1AF
1
1 unit
102
Single-flash lights with integrated
electronic flash
24 AC/DC
115 AC
230 AC
Red
A 8WD5320-0CB
1
1 unit
102
Green
D 8WD5320-0CC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD5320-0CD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD5320-0CE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
A 8WD5320-0CF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD5340-0CB
1
1 unit
102
Green
D 8WD5340-0CC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
D 8WD5340-0CD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
D 8WD5340-0CE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
D 8WD5340-0CF
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD5350-0CB
1
1 unit
102
Green
D 8WD5350-0CC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD5350-0CD
1
1 unit
102
Clear
A 8WD5350-0CE
1
1 unit
102
Blue
D 8WD5350-0CF
1
1 unit
102
Lights with integrated LED
Continuous lights
Blinklight lamps
Rotating lights
24 AC/DC
24 AC/DC
24 AC/DC
Red
A 8WD5320-5AB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD5320-5AC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD5320-5AD
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD5320-5BB
1
1 unit
102
Green
D 8WD5320-5BC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD5320-5BD
1
1 unit
102
Red
A 8WD5320-5DB
1
1 unit
102
Green
A 8WD5320-5DC
1
1 unit
102
Yellow
A 8WD5320-5DD
1
1 unit
102
For incandescent lamps and LEDs see Signaling Columns.
1)
Lamp not included in scope of supply. Please order separately.
* You can order this quantity or a multiple thereof.
Illustrations are approximate
Siemens IC 10 · 2011
10/115
10
Lights with integrated flash lamp
© Siemens AG 2010
8WD5 Integrated Signal Lamps
10
Notes
10/116
Siemens IC 10 · 2011